blob: c430ec3b8283f813bf13fdcec7bb9dc9aa244927 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaueab1dc62013-06-17 15:10:25 +02007 2013/06/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
727.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
737.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
757.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
767.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
777.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078
798. Logging
808.1. Log levels
818.2. Log formats
828.2.1. Default log format
838.2.2. TCP log format
848.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100858.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100868.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200878.3. Advanced logging options
888.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
898.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
908.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
918.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
928.4. Timing events
938.5. Session state at disconnection
948.6. Non-printable characters
958.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
968.8. Capturing HTTP headers
978.9. Examples of logs
98
999. Statistics and monitoring
1009.1. CSV format
1019.2. Unix Socket commands
102
103
1041. Quick reminder about HTTP
105----------------------------
106
107When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
108fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
109on almost anything found in the contents.
110
111However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
112formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
113correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
114
115
1161.1. The HTTP transaction model
117-------------------------------
118
119The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100120to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
122connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
123will involve a new connection :
124
125 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
126
127In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
128establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
129by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
130length.
131
132Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
133to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
134however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
135response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
136header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
137
138 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
139
140Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
141power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
142but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200143a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144
145A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
146keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
147second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
148page :
149
150 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
151
152This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
153latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
154correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
155the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100156server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
159connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
160everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
161established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
162sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
163while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
164another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
165sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
166http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
167mode.
168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
1701.2. HTTP request
171-----------------
172
173First, let's consider this HTTP request :
174
175 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100176 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
178 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
179 3 User-agent: my small browser
180 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
181 5 Accept: image/png
182
183
1841.2.1. The Request line
185-----------------------
186
187Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
188
189 - a METHOD : GET
190 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
191 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
192
193All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
194which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
195followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
196is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
197desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
198the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
199
200The URI itself can have several forms :
201
202 - A "relative URI" :
203
204 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
205
206 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
207 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
208
209 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
210
211 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
212
213 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
214 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
215 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
216 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
217 must accept this form too.
218
219 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
220 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
221 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200223 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
224 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
225 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
226 other protocols too.
227
228In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
229mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
230on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
231It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
232specific to the language, framework or application in use.
233
234
2351.2.2. The request headers
236--------------------------
237
238The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
239beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
240an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
241Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
242values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
243encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
244the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
245define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
246
247Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
248their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
249"Connection:" header).
250
251The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
252that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
253is one valid form of empty line.
254
255Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
256headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
257about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
258application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
259
260Important note:
261 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
262 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
263 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
264 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
265
266
2671.3. HTTP response
268------------------
269
270An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
271messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
272
273 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100274 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200275 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
276 2 Content-length: 350
277 3 Content-Type: text/html
278
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200279As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
280codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
281response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100282continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
283the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
284following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
285sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
286(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
287correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
288such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
289state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
290over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
291if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
292information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294
2951.3.1. The Response line
296------------------------
297
298Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
299
300 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
301 - a status code : 200
302 - a reason : OK
303
304The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200305 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
307 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
308 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
309 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
310
311Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100312"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
314messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
315or "Authentication Required".
316
317Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
318
319 Code When / reason
320 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
321 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
322 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
323 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100324 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326 400 for an invalid or too large request
327 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
328 accessing the stats page)
329 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
330 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
331 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
332 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
333 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
334 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
335 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
336 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
337 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
338
339The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3404.2).
341
342
3431.3.2. The response headers
344---------------------------
345
346Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
347the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
348details.
349
350
3512. Configuring HAProxy
352----------------------
353
3542.1. Configuration file format
355------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200356
357HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
358
359 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
360 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
361 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
362 "frontend" and "backend".
363
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
365referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
366delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100367preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100368escaped by doubling them.
369
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370
3712.2. Time format
372----------------
373
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100374Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100375values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
376otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
377numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
378for every keyword. Supported units are :
379
380 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
381 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
382 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
383 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
384 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
385 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
386
387
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003882.3. Examples
389-------------
390
391 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
392 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
393 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
394 global
395 daemon
396 maxconn 256
397
398 defaults
399 mode http
400 timeout connect 5000ms
401 timeout client 50000ms
402 timeout server 50000ms
403
404 frontend http-in
405 bind *:80
406 default_backend servers
407
408 backend servers
409 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
410
411
412 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
413 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
414 global
415 daemon
416 maxconn 256
417
418 defaults
419 mode http
420 timeout connect 5000ms
421 timeout client 50000ms
422 timeout server 50000ms
423
424 listen http-in
425 bind *:80
426 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
427
428
429Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
430
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100431 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432
433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004343. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200435--------------------
436
437Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
438are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
439of them have command-line equivalents.
440
441The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
442
443 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200444 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200445 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200446 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200447 - daemon
448 - gid
449 - group
450 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100451 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - nbproc
453 - pidfile
454 - uid
455 - ulimit-n
456 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200457 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200458 - node
459 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100460 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100461
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200462 * Performance tuning
463 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200464 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100465 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100466 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100467 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200468 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469 - noepoll
470 - nokqueue
471 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200473 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200474 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200475 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100476 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100477 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200478 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100479 - tune.maxaccept
480 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200481 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200482 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100483 - tune.rcvbuf.client
484 - tune.rcvbuf.server
485 - tune.sndbuf.client
486 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100487 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100488 - tune.ssl.lifetime
489 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100490 - tune.zlib.memlevel
491 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100492
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200493 * Debugging
494 - debug
495 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200496
497
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004983.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200499------------------------------------
500
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200501ca-base <dir>
502 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200503 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
504 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200505
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200506chroot <jail dir>
507 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
508 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
509 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
510 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
511 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
512 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100513
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100514cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
515 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
516 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
517 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
518 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
519 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
520 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
521 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
522 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
523 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
524 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
525 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
526 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
527 they overlap.
528
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200529crt-base <dir>
530 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
531 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
532 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
533
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200534daemon
535 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
536 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
537 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
538
539gid <number>
540 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
541 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
542 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100543 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
544 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200545 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100546
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547group <group name>
548 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
549 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100550
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200551log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200552 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
553 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100554 configured with "log global".
555
556 <address> can be one of:
557
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100558 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100559 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
560 port).
561
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100562 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
563 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
564 port).
565
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100566 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
567 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
568 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
569 writeable).
570
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100571 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
572 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
573 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
574 in Bourne shell.
575
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577
578 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
579 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
580 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
581
582 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200583 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
584 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
585 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
586 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
587 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
588 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200589
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200590 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100592log-send-hostname [<string>]
593 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
594 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
595 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
596 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
597 the logs.
598
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000599log-tag <string>
600 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
601 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
602 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
603 running on the same host.
604
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605nbproc <number>
606 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
607 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
608 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
609 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
610 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
611
612pidfile <pidfile>
613 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
614 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
615 starting the process. See also "daemon".
616
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100617stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200618 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
619 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
620 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
621 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
622 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
623 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
624 the number of processes used.
625
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200626stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
627 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
628 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
629 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
630 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200631
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200632 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
633 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
634 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200635
636stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
637 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
638 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100639 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200640
641stats maxconn <connections>
642 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
643 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
644
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645uid <number>
646 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
647 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
648 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
649 one. See also "gid" and "user".
650
651ulimit-n <number>
652 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
653 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
654 option.
655
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100656unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
657 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
658
659 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
660 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
661 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
662 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
663 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
664 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
665 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
666 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
667 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
668 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
669
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200670user <user name>
671 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
672 See also "uid" and "group".
673
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200674node <name>
675 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
676
677 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
678 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
679 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
680 traffic.
681
682description <text>
683 Add a text that describes the instance.
684
685 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
686 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
687 "<" and ">" characters.
688
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006903.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200691-----------------------
692
693maxconn <number>
694 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
695 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
696 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
697 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
698
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200699maxconnrate <number>
700 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
701 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
702 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
703 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
704 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
705 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
706 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
707 fairness.
708
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100709maxcomprate <number>
710 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
711 pers second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
712 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
713 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
714 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
715 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
716 default value.
717
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100718maxcompcpuusage <number>
719 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
720 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
721 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
722 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
723 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
724 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
725 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
726 process down and from introducing high latencies.
727
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100728maxpipes <number>
729 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
730 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
731 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
732 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
733 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
734 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
735
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200736maxsslconn <number>
737 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
738 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
739 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
740 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
741 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
742 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
743 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
744
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100745maxzlibmem <number>
746 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
747 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
748 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100749 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
750 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
751 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
752
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200753noepoll
754 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
755 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100756 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200757
758nokqueue
759 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
760 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
761 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
762
763nopoll
764 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
765 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100766 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100767 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200768
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100769nosplice
770 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
771 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
772 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100773 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100774 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
775 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
776 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
777 "option splice-response".
778
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200779spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
780 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
781 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
782 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
783 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
784 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
785
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200786tune.bufsize <number>
787 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
788 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
789 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
790 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
791 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
792 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
793 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
794 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400795 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
796 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
797 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200798
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200799tune.chksize <number>
800 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
801 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
802 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
803 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
804 checks whenever possible.
805
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100806tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
807 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
808 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
809 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
810 this value. The default value is 1.
811
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100812tune.http.cookielen <number>
813 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
814 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
815 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
816 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
817 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
818 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
819 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
820 to change this value.
821
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200822tune.http.maxhdr <number>
823 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
824 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
825 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
826 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
827 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
828 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
829 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
830 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
831 limit too high.
832
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100833tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100834 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
835 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
836 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
837 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
838 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
839 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
840 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
841 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
842 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
843 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100844
845tune.maxpollevents <number>
846 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
847 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
848 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
849 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
850 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
851
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200852tune.maxrewrite <number>
853 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
854 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
855 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
856 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
857 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
858 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
859 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
860 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
861 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
862 bufsize.
863
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200864tune.pipesize <number>
865 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
866 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
867 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
868 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
869 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
870 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
871
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100872tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
873tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
874 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
875 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
876 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
877 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
878 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
879 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
880 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
881
882tune.sndbuf.client <number>
883tune.sndbuf.server <number>
884 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
885 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
886 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
887 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
888 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
889 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
890 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
891 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
892 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
893 notifying haproxy again.
894
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100895tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100896 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
897 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
898 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
899 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block use approximatively
900 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
901 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
902 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
903 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
904 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100905 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
906 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100907
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100908tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
909 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
910 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 mn). It is important to understand that it
911 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
912 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
913 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
914 being used for too long.
915
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100916tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
917 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
918 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
919 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
920 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
921 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
922 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
923 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
924 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
925 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
926 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
927 best value.
928
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100929tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
930 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
931 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
932 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
933 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
934 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
935
936tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
937 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
938 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
939 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
940 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200941
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009423.3. Debugging
943--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200944
945debug
946 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
947 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
948 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
949 system startup.
950
951quiet
952 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
953 line argument "-q".
954
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009563.4. Userlists
957--------------
958It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
959http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
960it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
961
962userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100963 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100964 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
965
966group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100967 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100968 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
969 proceeded by "users" keyword.
970
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100971user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
972 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100973 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
974 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100975 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
976 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100977 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
978 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
979
980
981 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100982 userlist L1
983 group G1 users tiger,scott
984 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100985
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100986 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
987 user scott insecure-password elgato
988 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100989
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100990 userlist L2
991 group G1
992 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100993
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100994 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
995 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
996 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100997
998 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200999
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001000
10013.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001002----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001003It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1004haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1005pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1006identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1007or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1008Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1009known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1010the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1011process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1012during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1013tables.
1014
1015peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001016 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001017 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1018
1019peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1020 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1021 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1022 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1023 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1024 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1025 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1026
1027 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1028 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1029
1030 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1031 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1032 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1033 across all peers.
1034
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001035 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1036 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1037 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1038
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001039 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001040 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001041 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1042 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1043 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001044
1045 backend mybackend
1046 mode tcp
1047 balance roundrobin
1048 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1049 stick on src
1050
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001051 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1052 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001053
1054
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010554. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001056----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001057
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001058Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1059 - defaults <name>
1060 - frontend <name>
1061 - backend <name>
1062 - listen <name>
1063
1064A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1065its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1066section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001067section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
1069A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1070connections.
1071
1072A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1073to forward incoming connections.
1074
1075A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1076parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1077
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001078All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1079'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1080case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1081
1082Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1083logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1084proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1085However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1086name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1087
1088Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1089and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001090bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001091protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1092modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1093arbitrary criteria.
1094
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001095
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010964.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1097--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001098
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001099The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1100limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1101they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1102limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001103marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001104option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001105and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1106with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1107specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001108
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001109
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001110 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1111------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1112acl - X X X
1113appsession - - X X
1114backlog X X X -
1115balance X - X X
1116bind - X X -
1117bind-process X X X X
1118block - X X X
1119capture cookie - X X -
1120capture request header - X X -
1121capture response header - X X -
1122clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001123compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001124contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1125cookie X - X X
1126default-server X - X X
1127default_backend X X X -
1128description - X X X
1129disabled X X X X
1130dispatch - - X X
1131enabled X X X X
1132errorfile X X X X
1133errorloc X X X X
1134errorloc302 X X X X
1135-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1136errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001137force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001138fullconn X - X X
1139grace X X X X
1140hash-type X - X X
1141http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001142http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001143http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001144http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001145http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001146http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001147id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001148ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001149log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001150maxconn X X X -
1151mode X X X X
1152monitor fail - X X -
1153monitor-net X X X -
1154monitor-uri X X X -
1155option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1156option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1157option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1158option allbackups (*) X - X X
1159option checkcache (*) X - X X
1160option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1161option contstats (*) X X X -
1162option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1163option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1164option forceclose (*) X X X X
1165-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1166option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001167option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001168option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001169option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1170option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1171option httpchk X - X X
1172option httpclose (*) X X X X
1173option httplog X X X X
1174option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001175option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09001176option lb-agent-chk X - X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001177option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001178option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1179option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1180option logasap (*) X X X -
1181option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001182option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001183option nolinger (*) X X X X
1184option originalto X X X X
1185option persist (*) X - X X
1186option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001187option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001188option smtpchk X - X X
1189option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1190option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1191option splice-request (*) X X X X
1192option splice-response (*) X X X X
1193option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1194option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1195-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1196option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1197option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1198option tcpka X X X X
1199option tcplog X X X X
1200option transparent (*) X - X X
1201persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1202rate-limit sessions X X X -
1203redirect - X X X
1204redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1205redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1206reqadd - X X X
1207reqallow - X X X
1208reqdel - X X X
1209reqdeny - X X X
1210reqiallow - X X X
1211reqidel - X X X
1212reqideny - X X X
1213reqipass - X X X
1214reqirep - X X X
1215reqisetbe - X X X
1216reqitarpit - X X X
1217reqpass - X X X
1218reqrep - X X X
1219-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1220reqsetbe - X X X
1221reqtarpit - X X X
1222retries X - X X
1223rspadd - X X X
1224rspdel - X X X
1225rspdeny - X X X
1226rspidel - X X X
1227rspideny - X X X
1228rspirep - X X X
1229rsprep - X X X
1230server - - X X
1231source X - X X
1232srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001233stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001234stats auth X - X X
1235stats enable X - X X
1236stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001237stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001238stats realm X - X X
1239stats refresh X - X X
1240stats scope X - X X
1241stats show-desc X - X X
1242stats show-legends X - X X
1243stats show-node X - X X
1244stats uri X - X X
1245-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1246stick match - - X X
1247stick on - - X X
1248stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001249stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001250stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001251tcp-request connection - X X -
1252tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001253tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001254tcp-response content - - X X
1255tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001256timeout check X - X X
1257timeout client X X X -
1258timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1259timeout connect X - X X
1260timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1261timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1262timeout http-request X X X X
1263timeout queue X - X X
1264timeout server X - X X
1265timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1266timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001267timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001268transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001269unique-id-format X X X -
1270unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001271use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001272use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001273------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1274 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001275
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001276
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012774.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1278---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001279
1280This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1281
1282
1283acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1284 Declare or complete an access list.
1285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1286 no | yes | yes | yes
1287 Example:
1288 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1289 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1290 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1291
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001292 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001293
1294
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001295appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1296 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001297 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1299 no | no | yes | yes
1300 Arguments :
1301 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1302 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1303
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001304 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001305 checked in each cookie value.
1306
1307 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1308 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1309 milliseconds.
1310
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001311 request-learn
1312 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1313 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1314 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1315 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1316 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1317 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1318
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001319 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1320 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1321 data following this prefix.
1322
1323 Example :
1324 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1325
1326 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1327 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1328
1329 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1330 2 modes are currently supported :
1331 - path-parameters :
1332 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1333 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1334 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1335 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1336 - query-string :
1337 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1338 query string.
1339
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001340 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1341 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1342 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1343 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001344 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1345 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1346 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001347 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1348 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1349
1350 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1351
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001352 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1353 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1354 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1355
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001356 Example :
1357 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1358
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001359 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1360 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001361
1362
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001363backlog <conns>
1364 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1366 yes | yes | yes | no
1367 Arguments :
1368 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1369 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001370 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001371
1372 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1373 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1374 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1375 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1376 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1377 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1378 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1379 backlog parameter.
1380
1381 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1382 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1383 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1384
1385 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1386
1387
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001388balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001389balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001390 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1392 yes | no | yes | yes
1393 Arguments :
1394 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1395 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1396 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1397 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1398
1399 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1400 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1401 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1402 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001403 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001404 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001405 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1406 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1407 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1408 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1409 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1410 it, so that you don't worry.
1411
1412 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1413 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1414 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1415 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1416 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1417 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1418 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1419 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001420
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001421 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1422 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1423 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1424 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1425 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1426 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1427 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1428 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1429
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001430 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1431 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1432 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1433 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001434 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001435 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1436 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1437 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1438 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1439 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001440 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1441 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1442 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1443 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1444 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1445 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001446
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001447 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1448 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1449 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1450 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1451 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1452 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1453 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1454 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001455 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001456 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001457 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1458 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1459 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001460
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001461 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1462 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1463 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1464 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1465 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1466 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1467 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1468 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1469 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1470 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1471 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1472 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001473
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001474 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001475 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1476 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1477 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1478 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1479 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1480 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1481 URIs start with a leading "/".
1482
1483 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1484 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1485 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1486 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1487
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001488 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001489 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1490
1491 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001492 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1493 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1494 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1495 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1496 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1497 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1498 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1499 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1500 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1501 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1502 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1503 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1504 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1505 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1506 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1507 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1508 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1509 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1510 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001511
1512 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1513 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1514 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1515 server will receive the request.
1516
1517 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1518 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1519 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1520 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1521 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001522 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1523 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1524 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001525
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001526 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1527 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1528 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1529 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1530 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001531
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001532 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001533 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1534 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1535 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1536
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001537 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1538 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1539 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1540
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001541 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001542 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001543 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1544 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1545 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1546 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1547 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1548 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001549 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001550 used instead.
1551
1552 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1553 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1554 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1555 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1556
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001557 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1558 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1559 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1560
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001561 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001562
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001563 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001564 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1565 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001566
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001567 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001568 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001569
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001570 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1571 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1572 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001573
1574 Examples :
1575 balance roundrobin
1576 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001577 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001578 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1579 balance hdr(host)
1580 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001581
1582 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1583 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1584
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001585 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001586 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1587 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1588 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1589 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1590
1591 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1592 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1593 defaults to 16 kB.
1594
1595 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1596 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1597
1598 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1599 Round Robin.
1600
1601 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1602 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1603 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1604 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1605
1606 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1607
1608 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001609 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001610 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1611 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1612 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001613
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001614 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1615 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001616
1617
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001618bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1619bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001620 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1622 no | yes | yes | no
1623 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001624 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1625 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1626 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1627 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001628 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001629 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1630 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1631 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1632 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1633 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1634 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1635 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001636 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1637 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1638 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001639 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1640 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1641 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1642 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001643
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001644 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1645 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001646 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1647 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1648 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001649 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1650 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1651 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1652 the range.
1653
1654 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1655 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1656 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1657 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1658 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1659 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1660 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001661 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001662 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001663
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001664 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1665 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1666 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1667 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1668 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1669 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1670 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1671 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1672
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001673 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1674 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1675 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1676 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001677
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001678 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1679 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1680 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1681 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1682 in a frontend.
1683
1684 Example :
1685 listen http_proxy
1686 bind :80,:443
1687 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001688 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001689
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001690 listen http_https_proxy
1691 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001692 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001693
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001694 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1695 bind ipv6@:80
1696 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1697 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1698
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001699 listen external_bind_app1
1700 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1701
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001702 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001703 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001704
1705
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001706bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001707 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1709 yes | yes | yes | yes
1710 Arguments :
1711 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1712 may be used to override a default value.
1713
1714 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1715 option may be combined with other numbers.
1716
1717 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1718 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1719 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1720 missing from all processes.
1721
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001722 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1723 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1724 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1725 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1726 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001727
1728 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1729 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1730 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1731 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1732 and 'even' instances.
1733
1734 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1735 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1736 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1737 32.
1738
1739 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1740 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1741
1742 Example :
1743 listen app_ip1
1744 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001745 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001746
1747 listen app_ip2
1748 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001749 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001750
1751 listen management
1752 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001753 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001754
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001755 listen management
1756 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1757 bind-process 1-4
1758
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001759 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1760
1761
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001762block { if | unless } <condition>
1763 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1765 no | yes | yes | yes
1766
1767 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1768 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001769 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001770 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001771 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1772 "block" statements per instance.
1773
1774 Example:
1775 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1776 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1777 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1778 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001780 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001781
1782
1783capture cookie <name> len <length>
1784 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1786 no | yes | yes | no
1787 Arguments :
1788 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1789 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1790 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1791 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1792 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1793
1794 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1795 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1796 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1797 right if it exceeds <length>.
1798
1799 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1800 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1801 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1802 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1803
1804 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1805 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1806 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1807
1808 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1809 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1810 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001811 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1812 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1813 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001814
1815 Example:
1816 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1817
1818 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001819 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001820
1821
1822capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001823 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1825 no | yes | yes | no
1826 Arguments :
1827 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001828 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001829 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1830 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1831 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1832
1833 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1834 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1835 it exceeds <length>.
1836
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001837 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001838 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1839 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001840 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1841 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1842 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1843 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001844 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001845 environments to find where the request came from.
1846
1847 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1848 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1849 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1850 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001851
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001852 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1853 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1854 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1855 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1856 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001857
1858 Example:
1859 capture request header Host len 15
1860 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1861 capture request header Referrer len 15
1862
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001863 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001864 about logging.
1865
1866
1867capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001868 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1870 no | yes | yes | no
1871 Arguments :
1872 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001873 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001874 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1875 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1876 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1877
1878 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1879 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1880 it exceeds <length>.
1881
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001882 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001883 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1884 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1885 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001886 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1887 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1888 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1889 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001890
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001891 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
1892 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1893 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1894 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1895 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001896
1897 Example:
1898 capture response header Content-length len 9
1899 capture response header Location len 15
1900
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001901 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001902 about logging.
1903
1904
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001905clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001906 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1908 yes | yes | yes | no
1909 Arguments :
1910 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1911 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1912 as explained at the top of this document.
1913
1914 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1915 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1916 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1917 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1918 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1919 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1920 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1921 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001922 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001923 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1924 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1925
1926 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1927 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1928 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1929 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1930 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1931 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1932
1933 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1934 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1935
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001936 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1937 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001938
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001939compression algo <algorithm> ...
1940compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001941compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001942 Enable HTTP compression.
1943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1944 yes | yes | yes | yes
1945 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001946 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1947 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
1948 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
1949
1950 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001951 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001952 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
1953 data.
1954
1955 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
1956 support for zlib was built in.
1957
1958 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
1959 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
1960 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
1961 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
1962 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
1963 in.
1964
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001965 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001966 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001967 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
1968 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
1969 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
1970 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
1971 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001972
1973 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
1974 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
1975 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
1976 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
1977 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001978 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
1979 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
1980 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
1981 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
1982 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
1983 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001984
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001985 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001986 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
1987 "Accept-Encoding" header
1988 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01001989 * HTTP status code is not 200
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001990 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
1991 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
1992 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
1993 "multipart"
1994 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
1995 header
1996 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
1997 and later
1998 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
1999 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002000
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002001 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2002 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002003
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002004 Examples :
2005 compression algo gzip
2006 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002007
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002008contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002009 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2011 yes | no | yes | yes
2012 Arguments :
2013 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2014 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2015 as explained at the top of this document.
2016
2017 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002018 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002019 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002020 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2021 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2022 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2023 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2024
2025 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2026 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2027 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2028 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2029 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2030 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2031
2032 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2033 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2034 instead.
2035
2036 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2037 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2038
2039
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002040cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002041 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2042 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002043 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2045 yes | no | yes | yes
2046 Arguments :
2047 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2048 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2049 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2050 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2051 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2052 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2053 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2054 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2055 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2056
2057 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2058 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2059 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2060 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2061 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2062 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2063 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2064 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2065 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2066 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2067 "insert" and "prefix".
2068
2069 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002070 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002071
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002072 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002073 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2074 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2075 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2076 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2077 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2078 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2079 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2080 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2081 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2082 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002083
2084 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2085 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2086 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2087 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2088 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2089 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2090 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2091 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2092 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2093 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002094 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2095 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2096 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002097
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002098 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2099 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2100 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002101 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2102 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2103 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2104 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002105 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2106 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2107 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002108
2109 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2110 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2111 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2112 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2113 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2114 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2115 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2116 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2117 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2118
2119 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2120 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2121 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2122 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2123 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2124 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2125 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2126 persistence cookie in the cache.
2127 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2128
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002129 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2130 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2131 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2132 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2133 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2134 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2135 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2136 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2137 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2138 they logout.
2139
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002140 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2141 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2142 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2143 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2144
2145 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2146 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2147 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2148 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2149 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2150 this attribute.
2151
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002152 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002153 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002154 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2155 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2156 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2157 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2158 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2159 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002160
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002161 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2162 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2163 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2164 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2165 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2166 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2167 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2168 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2169 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2170 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2171 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2172 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2173 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2174 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2175 the site.
2176
2177 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2178 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2179 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2180 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2181 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2182 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2183 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2184 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2185 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2186 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2187 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2188 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2189 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2190 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2191 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2192 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2193
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002194 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2195 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2196 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2197 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002198
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002199 Examples :
2200 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2201 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2202 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002203 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002204
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002205 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002206 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002207
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002208
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002209default-server [param*]
2210 Change default options for a server in a backend
2211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2212 yes | no | yes | yes
2213 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002214 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2215 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2216 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2217 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002218
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002219 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002220 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2221
2222 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002223
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002224
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002225default_backend <backend>
2226 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2228 yes | yes | yes | no
2229 Arguments :
2230 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2231
2232 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2233 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2234 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2235 will catch all undetermined requests.
2236
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002237 Example :
2238
2239 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2240 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2241 default_backend dynamic
2242
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002243 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2244
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002245
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002246description <string>
2247 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2249 no | yes | yes | yes
2250 Arguments : string
2251
2252 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2253 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2254 it describes.
2255 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2256
2257
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002258disabled
2259 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2261 yes | yes | yes | yes
2262 Arguments : none
2263
2264 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2265 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2266 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2267 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2268 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2269 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2270 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2271
2272 See also : "enabled"
2273
2274
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002275dispatch <address>:<port>
2276 Set a default server address
2277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2278 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002279 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002280
2281 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2282 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2283 during start-up.
2284
2285 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2286 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2287 possible with normal servers.
2288
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002289 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002290 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2291 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2292 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2293 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2294
2295 See also : "server"
2296
2297
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002298enabled
2299 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2301 yes | yes | yes | yes
2302 Arguments : none
2303
2304 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2305 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2306
2307 See also : "disabled"
2308
2309
2310errorfile <code> <file>
2311 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2313 yes | yes | yes | yes
2314 Arguments :
2315 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002316 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002317
2318 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002319 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002320 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002321 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2322 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002323
2324 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2325 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2326 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2327
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002328 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2329
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002330 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2331 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2332 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2333 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2334
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002335 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2336 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2337 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2338 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2339 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2340 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2341
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002342 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2343 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2344 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002345 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002346 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2347
2348 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2349
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002350 Example :
2351 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2352 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2353 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2354
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002355
2356errorloc <code> <url>
2357errorloc302 <code> <url>
2358 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2360 yes | yes | yes | yes
2361 Arguments :
2362 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002363 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002364
2365 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2366 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2367 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2368 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2369 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2370
2371 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2372 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2373 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2374
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002375 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2376
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002377 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2378 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2379 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2380 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2381 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2382 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2383 request.
2384
2385 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2386
2387
2388errorloc303 <code> <url>
2389 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2391 yes | yes | yes | yes
2392 Arguments :
2393 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2394 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2395
2396 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2397 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2398 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2399 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2400 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2401
2402 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2403 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2404 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2405
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002406 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2407
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002408 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2409 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2410 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2411 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002412 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002413
2414 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2415
2416
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002417force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2418 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2419 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2420 no | yes | yes | yes
2421
2422 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2423 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2424 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2425 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2426 marked down for maintenance operations.
2427
2428 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2429 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2430 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2431 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2432 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2433 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2434 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2435 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2436 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2437
2438 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2439 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2440 is used.
2441
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002442 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002443 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002444
2445
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002446fullconn <conns>
2447 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2449 yes | no | yes | yes
2450 Arguments :
2451 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2452 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2453
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002454 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002455 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002456 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002457 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2458 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2459 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2460 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2461 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002462 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002463
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002464 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2465 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2466 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2467
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002468 Example :
2469 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2470 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2471 # connections.
2472 backend dynamic
2473 fullconn 10000
2474 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2475 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2476
2477 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2478
2479
2480grace <time>
2481 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002483 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002484 Arguments :
2485 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2486 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2487 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2488
2489 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2490 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002491 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002492 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2493
2494 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2495 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2496 simplify it.
2497
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002498
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002499hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002500 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2502 yes | no | yes | yes
2503 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002504 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2505 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002506
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002507 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2508 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2509 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2510 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2511 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2512 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2513 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2514 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2515 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2516 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002517
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002518 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2519 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2520 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2521 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2522 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2523 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2524 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2525 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2526 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2527 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2528 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2529 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2530 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002531 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2532 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002533
2534 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2535
2536 sdbm this function was created intially for sdbm (a public-domain
2537 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2538 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2539 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002540 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2541 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2542 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002543
2544 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2545 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002546 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2547 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2548 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2549 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2550
2551 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2552
2553 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2554 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2555 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2556 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2557 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2558 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2559 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2560 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2561 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2562 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2563 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2564 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002565
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002566 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2567 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2568 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002569
2570 See also : "balance", "server"
2571
2572
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002573http-check disable-on-404
2574 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002576 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002577 Arguments : none
2578
2579 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2580 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2581 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2582 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2583 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2584 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2585 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2586 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002587 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2588 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2589 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2590
2591 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2592
2593
2594http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002595 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002597 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002598 Arguments :
2599 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2600 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002601 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002602 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2603 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2604 details on the supported keywords.
2605
2606 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2607 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2608 with the usual backslash ('\').
2609
2610 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2611 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2612 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2613 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2614 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2615
2616 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002617 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002618 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2619 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2620 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2621
2622 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002623 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002624 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2625 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2626 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2627 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2628
2629 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002630 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002631 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2632 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2633 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2634 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2635 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2636 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2637 trace).
2638
2639 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002640 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002641 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2642 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2643 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2644 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2645 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2646 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2647
2648 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2649 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2650 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2651 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2652 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2653 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2654 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2655 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2656
2657 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2658 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2659
2660 Examples :
2661 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002662 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002663
2664 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002665 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002666
2667 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002668 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002669
2670 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002671 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002672
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002673 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002674
2675
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002676http-check send-state
2677 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2679 yes | no | yes | yes
2680 Arguments : none
2681
2682 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2683 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2684 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2685 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2686 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2687
2688 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2689 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2690 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2691 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2692 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2693 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2694 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2695 checked in multiple backends.
2696
2697 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2698 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2699
2700 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2701 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2702 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2703 one fails.
2704
2705 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2706 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2707 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2708
2709 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2710 server's queue.
2711
2712 Example of a header received by the application server :
2713 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2714 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2715
2716 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2717
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002718http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002719 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002720 set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> | set-tos <tos> |
2721 set-mark <mark> }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002722 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002723 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2724
2725 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2726 no | yes | yes | yes
2727
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002728 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2729 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2730 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2731 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2732 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002733
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002734 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2735 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2736 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2737
2738 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2739 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2740 are evaluated.
2741
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002742 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2743 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2744 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2745 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2746 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2747 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2748 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2749 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2750 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
2751 developped robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
2752 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2753
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002754 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2755 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2756 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2757 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2758 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2759
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002760 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2761 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2762 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
2763 "http-request" rules. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
2764
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002765 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2766 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2767 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2768 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2769 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2770 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2771 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2772 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2773
2774 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2775 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2776 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2777 external users.
2778
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002779 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2780 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2781 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2782 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2783 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2784 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2785 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2786 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2787
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002788 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2789 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2790 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2791 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2792 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2793 another equipment.
2794
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002795 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2796 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2797 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2798 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2799 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2800 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2801 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2802 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2803
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002804 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2805 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2806 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2807 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2808 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2809 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2810 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2811 admin privileges.
2812
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002813 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
2814
2815 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
2816 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
2817 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
2818 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002819
2820 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002821 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2822 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2823 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002824
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002825 http-request allow if nagios
2826 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2827 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2828 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002829
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002830 Example:
2831 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002832 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002833
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002834 Example:
2835 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
2836 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
2837 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
2838 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
2839 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
2840 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
2841 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
2842 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
2843 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
2844
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002845 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2846 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002847
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002848http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002849 set-header <name> <fmt> | set-log-level <level> |
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02002850 set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> }
2851 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002852 Access control for Layer 7 responses
2853
2854 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2855 no | yes | yes | yes
2856
2857 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2858 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2859 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2860 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2861 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
2862 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
2863
2864 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2865 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
2866 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
2867 current section.
2868
2869 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2870 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
2871 rules are evaluated.
2872
2873 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2874 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2875 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
2876 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
2877 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
2878 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
2879 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
2880
2881 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2882 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2883 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2884 external users.
2885
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002886 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2887 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2888 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2889 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2890 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2891 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2892 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2893 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2894
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002895 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2896 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2897 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2898 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2899 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2900 another equipment.
2901
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002902 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2903 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2904 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2905 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2906 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2907 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2908 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2909 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2910
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002911 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2912 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2913 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2914 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2915 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2916 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2917 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2918 admin privileges.
2919
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002920 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
2921
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08002922 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002923 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
2924 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
2925 rules.
2926
2927 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
2928 ACL usage.
2929
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002930http-send-name-header [<header>]
2931 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2932
2933 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2934 yes | no | yes | yes
2935
2936 Arguments :
2937
2938 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2939
2940 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2941 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2942 is added with the header string proved.
2943
2944 See also : "server"
2945
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002946id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002947 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2949 no | yes | yes | yes
2950 Arguments : none
2951
2952 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2953 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2954 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002955
2956
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002957ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2958 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2959 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2960 no | yes | yes | yes
2961
2962 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2963 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2964 and running).
2965
2966 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2967 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2968 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2969 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2970 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2971
2972 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2973 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2974
2975 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2976 "unless" condition is met.
2977
2978 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2979
2980
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002981log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002982log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002983no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002984 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2986 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002987
2988 Prefix :
2989 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2990 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2991 prefix does not allow arguments.
2992
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002993 Arguments :
2994 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2995 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2996 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2997 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2998 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2999 parameter.
3000
3001 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3002 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3003
3004 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3005 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3006 standard syslog port).
3007
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003008 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3009 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3010 standard syslog port).
3011
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003012 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3013 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3014 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3015 appropriately writeable).
3016
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003017 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3018 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3019 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3020 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3021
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003022 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3023
3024 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3025 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3026 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3027
3028 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3029 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3030 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003031 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3032 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3033 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3034 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3035 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003036
3037 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3038
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003039 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3040 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3041 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003042
3043 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3044 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3045 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3046 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3047
3048 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3049 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003050
3051 Example :
3052 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003053 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3054 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003055 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3056
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003057
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003058log-format <string>
3059 Allows you to custom a log line.
3060
3061 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3062
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003063
3064maxconn <conns>
3065 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3067 yes | yes | yes | no
3068 Arguments :
3069 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3070 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3071 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3072 closes.
3073
3074 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3075 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3076 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3077 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3078 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3079 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3080 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3081 properly tuned.
3082
3083 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3084 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3085 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3086
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003087 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3088
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003089 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3090
3091
3092mode { tcp|http|health }
3093 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3095 yes | yes | yes | yes
3096 Arguments :
3097 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3098 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3099 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3100 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3101
3102 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3103 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3104 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3105 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3106 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3107
3108 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003109 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3110 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3111 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3112 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3113 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3114 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3115 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003116
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003117 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3118 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3119 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003120
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003121 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003122 defaults http_instances
3123 mode http
3124
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003125 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003126
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003127
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003128monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003129 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3131 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003132 Arguments :
3133 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3134 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003135 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003136 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3137 backend and its backup.
3138
3139 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3140 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3141 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3142 servers in a list of backends.
3143
3144 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3145 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3146 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3147 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3148 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3149 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3150 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003151 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3152 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003153
3154 Example:
3155 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003156 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003157 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3158 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3159 monitor-uri /site_alive
3160 monitor fail if site_dead
3161
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003162 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003163
3164
3165monitor-net <source>
3166 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3168 yes | yes | yes | no
3169 Arguments :
3170 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3171 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3172 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3173 followed by a mask.
3174
3175 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3176 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003177 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003178 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3179
3180 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3181 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3182 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3183 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003184 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3185 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3186 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003187
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003188 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3189 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3190 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3191 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3192 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3193 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003194
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003195 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3196 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003197
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003198 Example :
3199 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3200 frontend www
3201 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3202
3203 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3204
3205
3206monitor-uri <uri>
3207 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3209 yes | yes | yes | no
3210 Arguments :
3211 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3212 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3213
3214 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3215 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3216 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3217 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3218 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3219 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3220 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3221 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3222
3223 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3224 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3225 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3226 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3227 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3228 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3229
3230 Example :
3231 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3232 frontend www
3233 mode http
3234 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3235
3236 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3237
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003238
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003239option abortonclose
3240no option abortonclose
3241 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3243 yes | no | yes | yes
3244 Arguments : none
3245
3246 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3247 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3248 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3249 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003250 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003251 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3252 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3253 encountered while delivering the response.
3254
3255 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3256 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3257 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3258 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3259 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3260 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003261 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003262 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003263 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003264 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3265 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3266 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3267
3268 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3269 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3270 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3271 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3272 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3273 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3274 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3275 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003276 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003277
3278 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3279 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3280
3281 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3282
3283
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003284option accept-invalid-http-request
3285no option accept-invalid-http-request
3286 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3288 yes | yes | yes | no
3289 Arguments : none
3290
3291 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3292 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3293 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3294 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3295 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3296 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3297 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3298 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003299 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3300 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3301 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3302 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3303 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3304 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003305
3306 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3307 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3308 been confirmed.
3309
3310 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3311 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003312 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3313 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003314 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3315
3316 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3317 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3318
3319 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3320 stats socket.
3321
3322
3323option accept-invalid-http-response
3324no option accept-invalid-http-response
3325 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3327 yes | no | yes | yes
3328 Arguments : none
3329
3330 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3331 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3332 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3333 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3334 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3335 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3336 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3337 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3338 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3339
3340 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3341 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3342 been confirmed.
3343
3344 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3345 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3346 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3347 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3348
3349 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3350 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3351
3352 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3353 stats socket.
3354
3355
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003356option allbackups
3357no option allbackups
3358 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3360 yes | no | yes | yes
3361 Arguments : none
3362
3363 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3364 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3365 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3366 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3367 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3368 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3369 order between the backup servers anymore.
3370
3371 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3372 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3373
3374 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3375 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3376
3377
3378option checkcache
3379no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003380 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3382 yes | no | yes | yes
3383 Arguments : none
3384
3385 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3386 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003387 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003388 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3389 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003390 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003391
3392 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003393 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003394 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003395 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3396 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003397 to the client are :
3398 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003399 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003400 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003401 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3402 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3403 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3404 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3405 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3406 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3407 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3408 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3409 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3410 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3411 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3412
3413 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003414 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003415 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003416 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003417 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3418
3419 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3420 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003421 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003422 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3423
3424 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3425 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3426
3427
3428option clitcpka
3429no option clitcpka
3430 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3432 yes | yes | yes | no
3433 Arguments : none
3434
3435 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3436 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3437 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3438 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3439
3440 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3441 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3442 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3443 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3444
3445 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3446 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3447 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3448 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3449 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3450
3451 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3452
3453 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3454 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3455 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3456
3457 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3458 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3459
3460 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3461
3462
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003463option contstats
3464 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3466 yes | yes | yes | no
3467 Arguments : none
3468
3469 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3470 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3471 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3472 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3473 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3474 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3475 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3476
3477
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003478option dontlog-normal
3479no option dontlog-normal
3480 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3482 yes | yes | yes | no
3483 Arguments : none
3484
3485 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3486 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3487 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3488 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3489 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3490 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3491 logged.
3492
3493 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3494 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3495 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3496
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003497 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003498 logging.
3499
3500
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003501option dontlognull
3502no option dontlognull
3503 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3505 yes | yes | yes | no
3506 Arguments : none
3507
3508 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3509 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3510 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3511 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3512 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3513 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3514 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3515
3516 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3517 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3518 would not be logged.
3519
3520 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3521 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003523 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003524
3525
3526option forceclose
3527no option forceclose
3528 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003530 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003531 Arguments : none
3532
3533 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3534 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3535 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3536 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3537 global session times in the logs.
3538
3539 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003540 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003541 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3542 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3543 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3544 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003545
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003546 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3547 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3548 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3549
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003550 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3551 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3552
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003553 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003554
3555
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003556option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003557 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3559 yes | yes | yes | yes
3560 Arguments :
3561 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3562 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003563 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003564 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003565
3566 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3567 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3568 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3569 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3570 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3571 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3572 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003573 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3574 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3575 possible that the client has already brought one.
3576
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003577 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003578 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003579 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3580 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003581 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3582 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003583
3584 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3585 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3586 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3587 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3588 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3589 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3590 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3591
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003592 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3593 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3594 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3595 are under the control of the end-user.
3596
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003597 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003598 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3599 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003600 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3601 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3602 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003603
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003604 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3605 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3606 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3607 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3608 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003609
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003610 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003611 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3612 frontend www
3613 mode http
3614 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3615
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003616 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3617 backend www
3618 mode http
3619 option forwardfor header X-Client
3620
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003621 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3622 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003623
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003624
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003625option http-no-delay
3626no option http-no-delay
3627 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3629 yes | yes | yes | yes
3630 Arguments : none
3631
3632 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3633 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3634 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3635 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3636 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3637 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3638 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3639 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3640 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3641 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3642 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3643 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3644 affected.
3645
3646 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3647 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3648 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3649 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3650 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3651 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3652 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3653 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3654 latency environments.
3655
3656
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003657option http-pretend-keepalive
3658no option http-pretend-keepalive
3659 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3661 yes | yes | yes | yes
3662 Arguments : none
3663
3664 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3665 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3666 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3667 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3668 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3669 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3670 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3671 consider the response complete.
3672
3673 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3674 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3675 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3676 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3677 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3678 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3679
3680 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3681 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3682 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3683 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3684 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3685 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3686 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3687
3688 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3689 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003690 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003691 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3692 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003693
3694 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3695 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3696
3697 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3698
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003699
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003700option http-server-close
3701no option http-server-close
3702 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3704 yes | yes | yes | yes
3705 Arguments : none
3706
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003707 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3708 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3709 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3710 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3711 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3712 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3713 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3714 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3715 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3716 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3717 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3718 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003719
3720 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3721 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3722 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3723 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003724 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3725 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003726
3727 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3728 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003729 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3730 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3731 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003732
3733 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3734 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3735
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003736 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3737 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003738
3739
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003740option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003741no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003742 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3744 yes | yes | yes | no
3745 Arguments : none
3746
3747 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3748 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3749 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3750 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3751 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3752 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3753 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3754
3755 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3756 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3757 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3758 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3759 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3760 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3761 request along its whole life.
3762
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003763 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3764 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3765 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3766 front of an existing proxy.
3767
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003768 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3769
3770 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3771 http-server-close".
3772
3773
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003774option httpchk
3775option httpchk <uri>
3776option httpchk <method> <uri>
3777option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3778 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3780 yes | no | yes | yes
3781 Arguments :
3782 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3783 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3784 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3785 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3786 ones.
3787
3788 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3789 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3790 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3791
3792 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3793 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3794 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3795 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3796 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3797
3798 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3799 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3800 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3801 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3802 the lack of any response.
3803
3804 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3805
3806 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3807 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3808 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3809
3810 Examples :
3811 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3812 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3813 backend https_relay
3814 mode tcp
3815 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3816 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3817
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09003818 See also : "option lb-agent-chk", "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk",
3819 "option mysql-check", "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and
3820 the "check", "port" and "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003821
3822
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003823option httpclose
3824no option httpclose
3825 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3827 yes | yes | yes | yes
3828 Arguments : none
3829
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003830 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3831 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3832 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3833 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3834 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3835 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3836 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003837
3838 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003839 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003840 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3841 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3842 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3843 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3844 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003845
3846 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3847 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3848 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003849 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3850 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003851
3852 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3853 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3854
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003855 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3856 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003857
3858
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003859option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003860 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3862 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003863 Arguments :
3864 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3865 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3866 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3867 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3868 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003869
3870 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3871 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3872 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3873 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3874 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3875 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3876 ports.
3877
3878 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3879
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003880 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3881 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3882 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3883 by default.
3884
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003885 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003886
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003887
3888option http_proxy
3889no option http_proxy
3890 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3892 yes | yes | yes | yes
3893 Arguments : none
3894
3895 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3896 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3897 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3898 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3899 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3900
3901 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3902 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3903 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3904 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003905 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003906 be analyzed.
3907
3908 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3909 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3910
3911 Example :
3912 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3913 backend direct_forward
3914 option httpclose
3915 option http_proxy
3916
3917 See also : "option httpclose"
3918
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003919
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003920option independent-streams
3921no option independent-streams
3922 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3924 yes | yes | yes | yes
3925 Arguments : none
3926
3927 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3928 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3929 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3930 receive data or not.
3931
3932 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3933 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3934 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3935 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3936 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3937 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3938 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3939 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3940 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3941 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3942 socket buffers.
3943
3944 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3945 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3946 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3947 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3948 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3949
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003950 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3951 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3952 deprecated.
3953
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003954 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003955
3956
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09003957option lb-agent-chk
3958 Use a TCP connection to obtain a metric of server health
3959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3960 yes | no | yes | yes
3961 Arguments : none
3962
3963 This alters health checking behaviour by connecting making a TCP
3964 connection and reading an ASCII string. The string should have one of
3965 the following forms:
3966
3967 * An ASCII representation of an positive integer percentage.
3968 e.g. "75%"
3969
3970 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
3971 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
3972
3973 * The string "drain".
3974
3975 This will cause the weight of a server to be set to 0, and thus it will
3976 not accept any new connections other than those that are accepted via
3977 persistence.
3978
3979 * The string "down", optionally followed by a description string.
3980
3981 Mark the server as down and log the description string as the reason.
3982
3983 * The string "stopped", optionally followed by a description string.
3984
3985 This currently has the same behaviour as down (iii).
3986
3987 * The string "fail", optionally followed by a description string.
3988
3989 This currently has the same behaviour as down (iii).
3990
3991 The use of an alternate check-port, used to obtain agent heath check
3992 information described above as opposed to the port of the service, may be
3993 useful in conjunction with this option.
3994
3995
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003996option ldap-check
3997 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3999 yes | no | yes | yes
4000 Arguments : none
4001
4002 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4003 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4004 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4005 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4006
4007 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4008 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4009
4010 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4011 configure it.
4012
4013 Example :
4014 option ldap-check
4015
4016 See also : "option httpchk"
4017
4018
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004019option log-health-checks
4020no option log-health-checks
4021 Enable or disable logging of health checks
4022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4023 yes | no | yes | yes
4024 Arguments : none
4025
4026 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
4027 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
4028 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
4029 of additional information is limited.
4030
4031 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
4032 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
4033
4034 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
4035
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004036
4037option log-separate-errors
4038no option log-separate-errors
4039 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4041 yes | yes | yes | no
4042 Arguments : none
4043
4044 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4045 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4046 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4047 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4048 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4049 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4050 provides very important information.
4051
4052 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4053 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4054 error logs.
4055
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004056 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004057 logging.
4058
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004059
4060option logasap
4061no option logasap
4062 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4064 yes | yes | yes | no
4065 Arguments : none
4066
4067 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4068 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4069 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4070 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4071 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4072 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4073 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004074 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004075 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4076 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4077
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004078 Examples :
4079 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4080 mode http
4081 option httplog
4082 option logasap
4083 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4084
4085 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4086 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4087 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4088 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4089
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004090 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004091 logging.
4092
4093
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004094option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
4095 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4097 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004098 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004099 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4100 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004101
4102 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4103 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4104 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4105 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4106 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4107 in the MySQL table, like this :
4108
4109 USE mysql;
4110 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4111 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4112
4113 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4114 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4115 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4116 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4117 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4118 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4119 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4120 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4121 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4122
4123 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4124 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004125
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004126 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004127
4128 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4129 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4130 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4131 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4132 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4133 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4134
4135 See also: "option httpchk"
4136
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01004137option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4138 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4140 yes | no | yes | yes
4141 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004142 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4143 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01004144
4145 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4146 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4147 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4148 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4149
4150 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004151
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004152option nolinger
4153no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004154 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004155 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4156 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004157 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004158
4159 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4160 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4161 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4162 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4163 connections.
4164
4165 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4166 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4167 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4168 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4169 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4170 this too.
4171
4172 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4173 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4174 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4175
4176 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4177 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4178 for servers.
4179
4180 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4181 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4182
4183
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004184option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4185 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4187 yes | yes | yes | yes
4188 Arguments :
4189 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4190 matching <network>
4191 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4192 header name.
4193
4194 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4195 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4196 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4197 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4198 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4199 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4200 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4201 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4202 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4203 possible that the client has already brought one.
4204
4205 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4206 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4207 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4208 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4209 header and requires different one.
4210
4211 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4212 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4213 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4214 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4215 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4216 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4217 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4218
4219 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4220 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4221 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4222 both are defined.
4223
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004224 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
4225 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
4226 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
4227 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
4228 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004229
4230 Examples :
4231 # Original Destination address
4232 frontend www
4233 mode http
4234 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4235
4236 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4237 backend www
4238 mode http
4239 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4240
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004241 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4242 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004243
4244
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004245option persist
4246no option persist
4247 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4248 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4249 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004250 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004251
4252 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4253 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4254 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4255 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4256 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4257 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4258 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4259 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4260 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4261 redirected to another valid server.
4262
4263 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4264 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4265
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004266 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004267
4268
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004269option redispatch
4270no option redispatch
4271 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4272 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4273 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004274 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004275
4276 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4277 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4278 be able to access the service anymore.
4279
4280 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4281 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4282
4283 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4284 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4285 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004286
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004287 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4288 "redisp" keywords.
4289
4290 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4291 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4292
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004293 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004294
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004295
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004296option redis-check
4297 Use redis health checks for server testing
4298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4299 yes | no | yes | yes
4300 Arguments : none
4301
4302 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4303 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4304 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4305 find the "+PONG" response message.
4306
4307 Example :
4308 option redis-check
4309
4310 See also : "option httpchk"
4311
4312
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004313option smtpchk
4314option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4315 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4317 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004318 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004319 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4320 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4321 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4322
4323 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4324 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4325 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4326
4327 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4328 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4329 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4330 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4331 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4332 dead server.
4333
4334 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4335 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4336 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4337 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4338
4339 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4340 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4341 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4342 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4343 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4344
4345 Example :
4346 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4347
4348 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4349
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004350
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004351option socket-stats
4352no option socket-stats
4353
4354 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4356 yes | yes | yes | no
4357
4358 Arguments : none
4359
4360
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004361option splice-auto
4362no option splice-auto
4363 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4365 yes | yes | yes | yes
4366 Arguments : none
4367
4368 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4369 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4370 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4371 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004372 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004373 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4374 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4375 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4376 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4377
4378 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4379 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4380 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4381 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4382 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4383 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4384 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4385 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4386 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4387 keyword.
4388
4389 Example :
4390 option splice-auto
4391
4392 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4393 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4394
4395 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4396 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4397
4398
4399option splice-request
4400no option splice-request
4401 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4403 yes | yes | yes | yes
4404 Arguments : none
4405
4406 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004407 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004408 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4409 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4410 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4411 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4412
4413 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4414
4415 Example :
4416 option splice-request
4417
4418 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4419 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4420
4421 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4422 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4423
4424
4425option splice-response
4426no option splice-response
4427 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4429 yes | yes | yes | yes
4430 Arguments : none
4431
4432 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004433 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004434 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4435 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4436 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4437 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4438
4439 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4440
4441 Example :
4442 option splice-response
4443
4444 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4445 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4446
4447 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4448 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4449
4450
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004451option srvtcpka
4452no option srvtcpka
4453 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4455 yes | no | yes | yes
4456 Arguments : none
4457
4458 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4459 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4460 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4461 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4462
4463 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4464 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4465 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4466 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4467
4468 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4469 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4470 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4471 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4472 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4473
4474 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4475
4476 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4477 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4478 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4479
4480 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4481 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4482
4483 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4484
4485
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004486option ssl-hello-chk
4487 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4489 yes | no | yes | yes
4490 Arguments : none
4491
4492 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4493 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4494 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4495 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4496 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4497 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4498 hello message.
4499
4500 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4501 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4502 messages, which is appreciable.
4503
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004504 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4505 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4506 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004507
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004508 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4509
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004510
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004511option tcp-smart-accept
4512no option tcp-smart-accept
4513 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4515 yes | yes | yes | no
4516 Arguments : none
4517
4518 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4519 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4520 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4521 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4522 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4523 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4524
4525 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4526 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4527 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4528 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4529
4530 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4531 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4532 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4533 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4534
4535 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4536 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4537 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4538
4539 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4540 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4541 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4542
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004543 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4544
4545
4546option tcp-smart-connect
4547no option tcp-smart-connect
4548 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4550 yes | no | yes | yes
4551 Arguments : none
4552
4553 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4554 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4555 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4556 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4557 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4558
4559 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4560 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4561 complex.
4562
4563 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4564 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4565 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4566
4567 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4568 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4569
4570 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4571
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004572
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004573option tcpka
4574 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4576 yes | yes | yes | yes
4577 Arguments : none
4578
4579 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4580 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4581 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4582 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4583
4584 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4585 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4586 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4587 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4588
4589 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4590 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4591 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4592 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4593 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4594
4595 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4596
4597 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4598 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4599 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4600 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4601 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4602 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4603 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4604 backends.
4605
4606 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4607
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004608
4609option tcplog
4610 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4612 yes | yes | yes | yes
4613 Arguments : none
4614
4615 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4616 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4617 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4618 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4619 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4620 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4621 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4622 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4623
4624 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4625
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004626 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004627
4628
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004629option transparent
4630no option transparent
4631 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004633 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004634 Arguments : none
4635
4636 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4637 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4638 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4639 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4640 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4641 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4642 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4643 appropriate server.
4644
4645 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4646 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4647
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004648 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004649 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004650
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004651
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004652persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004653persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004654 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4656 yes | no | yes | yes
4657 Arguments :
4658 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004659 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4660 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004661
4662 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4663 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4664 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4665 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4666 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4667 forwarded to this server.
4668
4669 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4670 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4671 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004672 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004673 a single "listen" section.
4674
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004675 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4676 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4677 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4678
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004679 Example :
4680 listen tse-farm
4681 bind :3389
4682 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4683 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4684 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4685 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4686 persist rdp-cookie
4687 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004688 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004689 balance rdp-cookie
4690 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4691 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4692
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004693 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4694 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004695
4696
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004697rate-limit sessions <rate>
4698 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4700 yes | yes | yes | no
4701 Arguments :
4702 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4703 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4704
4705 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4706 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4707 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4708 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4709 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4710 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4711
4712 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4713 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4714 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4715 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4716
4717 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4718 listen smtp
4719 mode tcp
4720 bind :25
4721 rate-limit sessions 10
4722 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4723
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004724 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4725 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4726 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004727
4728 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4729
4730
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004731redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4732redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4733redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004734 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4736 no | yes | yes | yes
4737
4738 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004739 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004740
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004741 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004742 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
4743 the HTTP "Location" header.
4744
4745 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4746 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4747 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4748 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4749 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
4750 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie).
4751
4752 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4753 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4754 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4755 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4756 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4757 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4758 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4759 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
4760 HTTPS.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004761
4762 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01004763 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
4764 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
4765 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
4766 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
4767 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
4768 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
4769 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
4770 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004771
4772 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4773 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4774
4775 - "drop-query"
4776 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4777 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4778 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4779 with a location-type redirect.
4780
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004781 - "append-slash"
4782 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4783 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4784 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4785 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4786
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004787 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4788 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4789 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4790 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4791 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4792 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4793 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4794
4795 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4796 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4797 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4798 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4799 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4800 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4801 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004802
4803 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4804 acl clear dst_port 80
4805 acl secure dst_port 8080
4806 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004807 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004808 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004809 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4810
4811 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004812 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4813 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4814 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004815 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004816
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004817 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4818 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4819 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4820
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004821 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01004822 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004823
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004824 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004825
4826
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004827redisp (deprecated)
4828redispatch (deprecated)
4829 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4830 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4831 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004832 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004833
4834 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4835 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4836 be able to access the service anymore.
4837
4838 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4839 redistribute them to a working server.
4840
4841 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4842 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4843 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004844
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004845 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4846 "option redispatch" instead.
4847
4848 See also : "option redispatch"
4849
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004850
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004851reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004852 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4854 no | yes | yes | yes
4855 Arguments :
4856 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4857 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004858 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004859
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004860 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4861 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4862
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004863 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4864 the last header of an HTTP request.
4865
4866 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4867 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4868 responses.
4869
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004870 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4871 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4872 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4873
4874 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4875 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004876
4877
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004878reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4879reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004880 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4882 no | yes | yes | yes
4883 Arguments :
4884 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4885 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4886 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4887 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4888 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4889 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4890 ignores case.
4891
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004892 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4893 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4894
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004895 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4896 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4897 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4898 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004899 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004900
4901 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4902 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4903
4904 Example :
4905 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4906 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4907 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4908
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004909 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4910 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004911
4912
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004913reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4914reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004915 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4917 no | yes | yes | yes
4918 Arguments :
4919 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4920 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4921 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4922 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4923 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4924 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4925
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004926 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4927 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4928
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004929 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4930 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4931 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4932 next servers.
4933
4934 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4935 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4936 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4937
4938 Example :
4939 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4940 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4941 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4942
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004943 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4944 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004945
4946
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004947reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4948reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004949 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4951 no | yes | yes | yes
4952 Arguments :
4953 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4954 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4955 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4956 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4957 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4958 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4959 case.
4960
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004961 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4962 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4963
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004964 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4965 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4966 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4967 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004968 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004969
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004970 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004971 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004972 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004973
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004974 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4975 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4976
4977 Example :
4978 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4979 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4980 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4981
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004982 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4983 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004984
4985
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004986reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4987reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004988 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4990 no | yes | yes | yes
4991 Arguments :
4992 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4993 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4994 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4995 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4996 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4997 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4998 case.
4999
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005000 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5001 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5002
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005003 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5004 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5005 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5006 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5007
5008 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5009 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5010
5011 Example :
5012 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5013 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5014 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5015 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5016
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005017 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5018 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005019
5020
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005021reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5022reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005023 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5025 no | yes | yes | yes
5026 Arguments :
5027 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5028 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5029 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5030 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5031 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5032 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5033
5034 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5035 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5036 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5037 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005038 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005039
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005040 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5041 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5042
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005043 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5044 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5045 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5046
5047 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5048 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5049 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5050 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5051 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5052
5053 Example :
5054 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005055 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005056 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5057 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5058
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005059 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5060 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005061
5062
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005063reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5064reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005065 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5067 no | yes | yes | yes
5068 Arguments :
5069 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5070 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5071 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5072 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5073 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5074 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5075 ignores case.
5076
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005077 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5078 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5079
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005080 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5081 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005082 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5083 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5084 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005085 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5086 not set.
5087
5088 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5089 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5090 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5091 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5092 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5093
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005094 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005095 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5096 # block all others.
5097 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5098 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5099
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005100 # block bad guys
5101 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5102 reqitarpit . if badguys
5103
5104 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5105 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005106
5107
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005108retries <value>
5109 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5110 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5111 yes | no | yes | yes
5112 Arguments :
5113 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5114 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5115 default value is 3.
5116
5117 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5118 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5119 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5120
5121 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5122 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5123
5124 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5125 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5126
5127 See also : "option redispatch"
5128
5129
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005130rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005131 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5133 no | yes | yes | yes
5134 Arguments :
5135 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5136 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005137 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005138
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005139 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5140 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5141
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005142 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5143 the last header of an HTTP response.
5144
5145 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5146 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5147 responses.
5148
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005149 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5150 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005151
5152
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005153rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5154rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005155 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5157 no | yes | yes | yes
5158 Arguments :
5159 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5160 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5161 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5162 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5163 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5164 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5165 ignores case.
5166
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005167 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5168 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5169
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005170 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5171 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005172 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005173 client.
5174
5175 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5176 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5177 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5178
5179 Example :
5180 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005181 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005182
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005183 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5184 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005185
5186
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005187rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5188rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005189 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5191 no | yes | yes | yes
5192 Arguments :
5193 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5194 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5195 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5196 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5197 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5198 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5199 ignores case.
5200
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005201 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5202 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5203
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005204 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5205 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5206 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5207 case-sensitive.
5208
5209 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005210 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5211 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5212 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005213
5214 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5215 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5216
5217 Example :
5218 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5219 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5220
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005221 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5222 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005223
5224
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005225rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5226rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005227 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5229 no | yes | yes | yes
5230 Arguments :
5231 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5232 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5233 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5234 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5235 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5236 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5237 ignores case.
5238
5239 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5240 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5241 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5242 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005243 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005244
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005245 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5246 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5247
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005248 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5249 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5250 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5251
5252 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5253 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5254 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5255 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5256 are not case-sensitive.
5257
5258 Example :
5259 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5260 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5261
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005262 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5263 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005264
5265
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005266server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005267 Declare a server in a backend
5268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5269 no | no | yes | yes
5270 Arguments :
5271 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005272 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005273 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005274
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005275 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5276 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5277 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5278 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005279 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5280 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5281 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5282 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5283 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005284 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5285 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5286 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5287 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5288 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5289 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5290 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005291 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5292 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5293 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5294 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005295
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005296 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005297 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5298 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5299 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5300 adding this value to the client's port.
5301
5302 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5303 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005304 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005305
5306 Examples :
5307 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5308 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005309 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005310 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5311 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5312 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005313
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005314 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5315 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005316
5317
5318source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005319source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005320source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005321 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5323 yes | no | yes | yes
5324 Arguments :
5325 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5326 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005327
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005328 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005329 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5330 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5331 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5332 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5333 supported prefixes are :
5334 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5335 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5336 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005337 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5338 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5339 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5340 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005341
5342 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5343 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005344 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5345 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5346 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005347
5348 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5349 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5350 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5351 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5352 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5353 <addr>.
5354
5355 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5356 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5357 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5358 port.
5359
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005360 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5361 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5362 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5363 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005364 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005365 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5366 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5367 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5368 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5369 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5370 HTTP header.
5371
5372 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5373 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005374 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005375 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5376 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5377 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5378 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5379 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5380 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5381 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5382
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005383 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5384 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5385 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5386 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5387 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5388 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5389
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005390 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5391 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5392 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5393 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5394
5395 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5396 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5397 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5398 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5399 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5400 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5401
5402 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5403 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5404 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5405 there are two methods :
5406
5407 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5408 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5409 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5410 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5411 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5412 of the client ranges may be used.
5413
5414 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5415 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5416 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5417 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5418 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5419 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5420 same session.
5421
5422 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5423 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5424 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5425 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5426 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5427 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5428
5429 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5430 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5431 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005432 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005433
5434 Examples :
5435 backend private
5436 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5437 source 192.168.1.200
5438
5439 backend transparent_ssl1
5440 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5441 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5442
5443 backend transparent_ssl2
5444 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5445 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5446 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5447
5448 backend transparent_ssl3
5449 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5450 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5451 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5452
5453 backend transparent_smtp
5454 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5455 # with Tproxy version 4.
5456 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5457
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005458 backend transparent_http
5459 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5460 # proxy.
5461 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5462
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005463 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005464 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5465
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005466
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005467srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5468 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5470 yes | no | yes | yes
5471 Arguments :
5472 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5473 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5474 as explained at the top of this document.
5475
5476 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5477 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5478 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5479 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5480 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5481 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5482 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5483
5484 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5485 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5486 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5487 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5488 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005489 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005490 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005491 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005492
5493 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5494 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5495 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5496 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5497 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5498 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5499
5500 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5501 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5502
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005503 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5504 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005505
5506
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005507stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5508 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5510 no | no | yes | yes
5511
5512 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5513 matched.
5514
5515 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5516 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5517
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005518 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5519 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5520 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5521
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005522 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5523 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5524 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5525 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005526
5527 Example :
5528 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5529 backend stats_localhost
5530 stats enable
5531 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5532
5533 Example :
5534 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5535 backend stats_auth
5536 stats enable
5537 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5538 stats admin if TRUE
5539
5540 Example :
5541 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5542 userlist stats-auth
5543 group admin users admin
5544 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5545 group readonly users haproxy
5546 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5547
5548 backend stats_auth
5549 stats enable
5550 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5551 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5552 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5553 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5554
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005555 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5556 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5557 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005558
5559
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005560stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5561 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5563 yes | no | yes | yes
5564 Arguments :
5565 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5566
5567 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5568
5569 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5570 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5571 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5572 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5573 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5574 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5575
5576 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5577 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5578 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005579 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005580
5581 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5582 report using "stats scope".
5583
5584 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5585 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5586 unobvious parameters.
5587
5588 Example :
5589 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5590 backend public_www
5591 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5592 stats enable
5593 stats hide-version
5594 stats scope .
5595 stats uri /admin?stats
5596 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5597 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5598 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5599
5600 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5601 backend private_monitoring
5602 stats enable
5603 stats uri /admin?stats
5604 stats refresh 5s
5605
5606 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5607
5608
5609stats enable
5610 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5612 yes | no | yes | yes
5613 Arguments : none
5614
5615 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5616 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5617 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5618 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5619 - stats auth : no authentication
5620 - stats scope : no restriction
5621
5622 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5623 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5624 unobvious parameters.
5625
5626 Example :
5627 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5628 backend public_www
5629 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5630 stats enable
5631 stats hide-version
5632 stats scope .
5633 stats uri /admin?stats
5634 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5635 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5636 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5637
5638 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5639 backend private_monitoring
5640 stats enable
5641 stats uri /admin?stats
5642 stats refresh 5s
5643
5644 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5645
5646
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005647stats hide-version
5648 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5650 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005651 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005652
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005653 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5654 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5655 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5656 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5657 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5658 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005659
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005660 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5661 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5662 unobvious parameters.
5663
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005664 Example :
5665 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5666 backend public_www
5667 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005668 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005669 stats hide-version
5670 stats scope .
5671 stats uri /admin?stats
5672 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5673 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5674 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005675
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005676 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5677 backend private_monitoring
5678 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005679 stats uri /admin?stats
5680 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005681
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005682 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005683
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005684
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005685stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5686 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5687 Access control for statistics
5688
5689 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5690 no | no | yes | yes
5691
5692 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5693 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5694 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5695 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5696 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5697 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5698
5699 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5700 instance.
5701
5702 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5703 about ACL usage.
5704
5705
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005706stats realm <realm>
5707 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5709 yes | no | yes | yes
5710 Arguments :
5711 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5712 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5713 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5714
5715 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5716 using a backslash ('\').
5717
5718 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5719 only related to authentication.
5720
5721 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5722 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5723 unobvious parameters.
5724
5725 Example :
5726 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5727 backend public_www
5728 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5729 stats enable
5730 stats hide-version
5731 stats scope .
5732 stats uri /admin?stats
5733 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5734 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5735 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5736
5737 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5738 backend private_monitoring
5739 stats enable
5740 stats uri /admin?stats
5741 stats refresh 5s
5742
5743 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5744
5745
5746stats refresh <delay>
5747 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5749 yes | no | yes | yes
5750 Arguments :
5751 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5752 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5753 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5754 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5755 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5756 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5757
5758 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5759 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5760 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5761 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5762
5763 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5764 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5765 unobvious parameters.
5766
5767 Example :
5768 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5769 backend public_www
5770 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5771 stats enable
5772 stats hide-version
5773 stats scope .
5774 stats uri /admin?stats
5775 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5776 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5777 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5778
5779 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5780 backend private_monitoring
5781 stats enable
5782 stats uri /admin?stats
5783 stats refresh 5s
5784
5785 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5786
5787
5788stats scope { <name> | "." }
5789 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5791 yes | no | yes | yes
5792 Arguments :
5793 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5794 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5795 section in which the statement appears.
5796
5797 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5798 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5799 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5800 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5801 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5802 exists.
5803
5804 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5805 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5806 unobvious parameters.
5807
5808 Example :
5809 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5810 backend public_www
5811 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5812 stats enable
5813 stats hide-version
5814 stats scope .
5815 stats uri /admin?stats
5816 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5817 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5818 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5819
5820 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5821 backend private_monitoring
5822 stats enable
5823 stats uri /admin?stats
5824 stats refresh 5s
5825
5826 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5827
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005828
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005829stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005830 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5832 yes | no | yes | yes
5833
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005834 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005835 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5836
5837 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5838 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5839
5840 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5841 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005842 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005843
5844 Example :
5845 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5846 backend private_monitoring
5847 stats enable
5848 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5849 stats uri /admin?stats
5850 stats refresh 5s
5851
5852 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5853 global section.
5854
5855
5856stats show-legends
5857 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5858 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5859 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5860 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5861 - IP (socket, server)
5862 - cookie (backend, server)
5863
5864 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5865 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005866 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005867
5868 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5869
5870
5871stats show-node [ <name> ]
5872 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5874 yes | no | yes | yes
5875 Arguments:
5876 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5877 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5878
5879 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5880 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005881 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005882
5883 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5884 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5885 unobvious parameters.
5886
5887 Example:
5888 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5889 backend private_monitoring
5890 stats enable
5891 stats show-node Europe-1
5892 stats uri /admin?stats
5893 stats refresh 5s
5894
5895 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5896 section.
5897
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005898
5899stats uri <prefix>
5900 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5902 yes | no | yes | yes
5903 Arguments :
5904 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5905 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5906 query string.
5907
5908 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5909 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5910 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5911 possible to reach it in the application.
5912
5913 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005914 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005915 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5916 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5917 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5918 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5919
5920 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5921 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5922 an address or a port to statistics only.
5923
5924 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5925 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5926 unobvious parameters.
5927
5928 Example :
5929 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5930 backend public_www
5931 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5932 stats enable
5933 stats hide-version
5934 stats scope .
5935 stats uri /admin?stats
5936 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5937 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5938 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5939
5940 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5941 backend private_monitoring
5942 stats enable
5943 stats uri /admin?stats
5944 stats refresh 5s
5945
5946 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5947
5948
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005949stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5950 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005952 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005953
5954 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02005955 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005956 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5957 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5958 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5959
5960 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5961 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5962 the "stick-table" statement.
5963
5964 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5965 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5966 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5967 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5968 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5969
5970 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5971 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5972 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5973 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5974 transformation rules.
5975
5976 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5977 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5978 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5979 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5980 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5981 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5982 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5983
5984 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5985 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5986 ACL based conditions.
5987
5988 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5989 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5990 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5991 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5992
5993 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5994 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5995 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5996 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5997
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005998 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5999 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6000 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6001
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006002 Example :
6003 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6004 # last 30 minutes
6005 backend pop
6006 mode tcp
6007 balance roundrobin
6008 stick store-request src
6009 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6010 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6011 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6012
6013 backend smtp
6014 mode tcp
6015 balance roundrobin
6016 stick match src table pop
6017 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6018 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6019
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006020 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6021 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006022
6023
6024stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6025 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6027 no | no | yes | yes
6028
6029 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6030 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6031 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6032 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6033
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006034 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6035 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6036 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6037
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006038 Examples :
6039 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006040 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006041
6042 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6043 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6044 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6045
6046
6047 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6048 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6049 backend http
6050 mode http
6051 balance roundrobin
6052 stick on src table https
6053 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6054 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6055 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6056
6057 backend https
6058 mode tcp
6059 balance roundrobin
6060 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6061 stick on src
6062 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6063 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6064
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006065 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006066
6067
6068stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6069 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6071 no | no | yes | yes
6072
6073 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006074 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006075 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6076 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6077 server is selected.
6078
6079 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6080 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6081 the "stick-table" statement.
6082
6083 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6084 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6085 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6086 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6087 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6088 address.
6089
6090 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6091 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6092 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6093 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6094 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6095 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6096 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6097 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6098 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6099 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6100
6101 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6102 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6103 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6104 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6105 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6106 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6107 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6108
6109 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6110 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6111 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6112 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6113
6114 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6115 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6116 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6117 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6118 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6119 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
6120 another protocol or access method.
6121
6122 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6123 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6124 the request.
6125
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006126 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6127 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6128 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6129
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006130 Example :
6131 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6132 # last 30 minutes
6133 backend pop
6134 mode tcp
6135 balance roundrobin
6136 stick store-request src
6137 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6138 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6139 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6140
6141 backend smtp
6142 mode tcp
6143 balance roundrobin
6144 stick match src table pop
6145 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6146 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6147
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006148 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6149 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006150
6151
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006152stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006153 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6154 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006155 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
6156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006157 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006158
6159 Arguments :
6160 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6161 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6162 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6163 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6164
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006165 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6166 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6167 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6168 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6169
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006170 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6171 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6172 instance.
6173
6174 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6175 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6176 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6177 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6178 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6179 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006180 to 32 characters.
6181
6182 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6183 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6184 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6185 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
6186 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6187 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006188
6189 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006190 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6191 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006192 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6193 increase.
6194
6195 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006196 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6197 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6198 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006199
6200 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6201 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6202 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6203 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6204 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6205 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6206 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6207 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6208 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6209 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6210 parameter (see below).
6211
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006212 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6213 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6214 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6215 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6216 soft restart.
6217
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006218 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6219
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006220 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6221 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6222 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6223 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6224 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006225 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006226 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6227 if not expiration delay is specified.
6228
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006229 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6230 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6231 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6232 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006233 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6234 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6235 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6236 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6237 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6238 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6239 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6240 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6241 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6242 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6243 types and their arguments.
6244
6245 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6246 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6247 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6248 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6249
6250 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6251 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6252 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6253 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6254
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006255 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6256 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6257 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6258 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6259 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6260 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6261
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006262 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6263 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6264 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6265 they were received.
6266
6267 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6268 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6269 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6270 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6271 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6272
6273 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6274 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6275 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6276 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6277 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6278
6279 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6280 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6281 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6282
6283 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6284 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6285 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6286 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6287 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6288
6289 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6290 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6291 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6292 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6293 the client side.
6294
6295 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6296 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6297 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6298 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6299 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6300 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6301 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6302
6303 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6304 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6305 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6306 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6307 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6308 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6309 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6310
6311 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6312 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6313 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6314 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6315 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6316 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6317
6318 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6319 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6320 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6321 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6322
6323 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6324 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6325 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6326 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6327 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6328 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6329 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6330 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6331 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6332 recommended for better fairness.
6333
6334 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6335 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6336 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6337 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6338
6339 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6340 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6341 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6342 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6343 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6344 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6345 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6346 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6347 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6348 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006349
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006350 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6351 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006352 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6353 reference it.
6354
6355 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6356 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6357 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6358 as an exclusive stickiness.
6359
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006360 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6361 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6362 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6363 something that can be ignored.
6364
6365 Example:
6366 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6367 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6368 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6369 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6370
6371 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006372 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006373
6374
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006375stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6376 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6378 no | no | yes | yes
6379
6380 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006381 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006382 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6383 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6384 server is selected.
6385
6386 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6387 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6388 the "stick-table" statement.
6389
6390 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6391 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6392 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6393 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6394
6395 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6396 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6397 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6398 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6399 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6400 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006401 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006402 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6403 rules.
6404
6405 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6406 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6407 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6408 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6409 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6410 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6411 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6412
6413 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6414 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6415 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6416 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6417
6418 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6419 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6420 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6421 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6422 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6423 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
6424 another protocol or access method.
6425
6426 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6427
6428 Example :
6429 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6430 backend https
6431 mode tcp
6432 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006433 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006434 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006435
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006436 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6437 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6438
6439 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6440 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6441 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6442
6443 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6444 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006445
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006446 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6447 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6448 # at offset 44.
6449
6450 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6451 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6452
6453 # Learn on response if server hello.
6454 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006455
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006456 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6457 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6458
6459 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6460 extraction.
6461
6462
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006463tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6464 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6466 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006467 Arguments :
6468 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006469 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6470 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006471
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006472 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006473
6474 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6475 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006476 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6477 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6478 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6479 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6480 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6481 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006482
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006483 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6484 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6485 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6486 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006487
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006488 Three types of actions are supported :
6489 - accept :
6490 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6491 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6492 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006493
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006494 - reject :
6495 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6496 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6497 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6498 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6499 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6500 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6501 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6502 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6503 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6504 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6505 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6506 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006507
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006508 - expect-proxy layer4 :
6509 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
6510 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
6511 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
6512 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
6513 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
6514 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
6515 hosts.
6516
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006517 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006518 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6519 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6520 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006521 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6522 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006523 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006524 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
6525 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
6526 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
6527 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
6528 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006529
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006530 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006531 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006532 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006533 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
6534 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
6535 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
6536 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006537
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006538 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6539 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6540 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6541 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006542
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006543 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6544 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6545 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6546 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6547 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006548 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
6549 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
6550 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
6551 layer7 information is extracted.
6552
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006553 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6554 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6555 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6556 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6557 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006558
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006559 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6560 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6561 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006562
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006563 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6564 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6565 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006566
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006567 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006568 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006569 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006570
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006571 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6572 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6573 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006574
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006575 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006576 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
6577 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006578
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006579 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
6580
6581 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
6582
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006583 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6584
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006585 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006586
6587
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006588tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6589 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006591 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006592 Arguments :
6593 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006594 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6595 and "track-sc2". See "tcp-request connection" above for their
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02006596 signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006597
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006598 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006599
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006600 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6601 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6602 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6603 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6604 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006605
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006606 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6607 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6608 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6609 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6610 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6611 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6612 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6613 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6614 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006615
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006616 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6617 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6618 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6619 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006620
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006621 Three types of actions are supported :
6622 - accept :
6623 - reject :
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006624 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006625
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006626 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6627 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006628
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006629 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6630 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6631 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006632 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. This makes a subtle
6633 difference because tracking rules in "frontend" and "listen" section last for
6634 all the session, as opposed to the backend rules. The difference appears when
6635 some layer 7 information is tracked. While there is nothing mandatory about
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006636 it, it is recommended to use the track-sc0 pointer to track per-frontend
6637 counters and track-sc1 to track per-backend counters, but this is just a
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02006638 guideline and all counters may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006639
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006640 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006641 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6642 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006643
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006644 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006645 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6646 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6647 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6648 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6649 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006650
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006651 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
6652 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
6653 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
6654 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
6655
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006656 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006657 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6658 # and reject everything else.
6659 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6660 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006661 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006662 tcp-request content reject
6663
6664 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006665 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6666 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6667 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006668 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006669
6670 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6671 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6672 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006673 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006674 tcp-request content reject
6675
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006676 Example:
6677 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
6678 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006679 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006680
6681 Example:
6682 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
6683 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006684 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006685
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006686 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6687 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6688
6689 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006690 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006691 # protecting all our sites
6692 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006693 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
6694 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006695 ...
6696 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6697
6698 backend http_dynamic
6699 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006700 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006701 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006702 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
6703 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
6704 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006705 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006706
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006707 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006708
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006709 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006710
6711
6712tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6713 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006715 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006716 Arguments :
6717 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6718 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6719 as explained at the top of this document.
6720
6721 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6722 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6723 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6724 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6725 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6726
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006727 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6728 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6729 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6730 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6731
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006732 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6733 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006734 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006735 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006736 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6737 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6738 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6739 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006740
6741 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6742 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6743 it pass through unaffected.
6744
6745 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6746 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6747 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006748 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006749 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6750 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006751 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6752 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6753 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006754
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006755 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006756 "timeout client".
6757
6758
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006759tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6760 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6762 no | no | yes | yes
6763 Arguments :
6764 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02006765 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006766
6767 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6768
6769 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6770 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6771 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02006772 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
6773 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006774
6775 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6776
6777 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6778 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6779 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6780 inserted.
6781
6782 Two types of actions are supported :
6783 - accept :
6784 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6785 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6786 the rules evaluation.
6787
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02006788 - close :
6789 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
6790 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
6791 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
6792 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
6793 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
6794 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
6795 connections which take signifiant resources on servers with certain
6796 protocols.
6797
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006798 - reject :
6799 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6800 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006801 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006802
6803 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6804 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6805 for changing the default action to a reject.
6806
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006807 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6808 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6809 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6810 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006811 period.
6812
6813 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6814
6815 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6816
6817
6818tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6819 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6821 no | no | yes | yes
6822 Arguments :
6823 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6824 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6825 as explained at the top of this document.
6826
6827 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6828
6829
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006830timeout check <timeout>
6831 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6832 established.
6833
6834 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6835 yes | no | yes | yes
6836 Arguments:
6837 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6838 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6839 as explained at the top of this document.
6840
6841 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6842 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6843 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6844 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006845 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6846 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6847 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006848
6849 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6850 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6851
6852 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6853 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006854 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006855
6856 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6857 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6858 forget about it.
6859
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006860 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6861 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006862
6863
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006864timeout client <timeout>
6865timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6866 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6868 yes | yes | yes | no
6869 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006870 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006871 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6872 as explained at the top of this document.
6873
6874 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6875 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6876 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6877 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6878 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6879 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6880 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6881 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006882 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006883 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006884 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6885 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6886 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006887
6888 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6889 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6890 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6891 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6892 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6893 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6894
6895 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6896 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6897 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6898
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006899 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006900
6901
6902timeout connect <timeout>
6903timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6904 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6906 yes | no | yes | yes
6907 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006908 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006909 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6910 as explained at the top of this document.
6911
6912 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006913 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006914 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006915 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006916 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6917 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006918
6919 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6920 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6921 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6922 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6923 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6924 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6925
6926 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6927 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6928 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6929
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006930 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6931 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006932
6933
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006934timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6935 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6937 yes | yes | yes | yes
6938 Arguments :
6939 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6940 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6941 as explained at the top of this document.
6942
6943 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6944 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6945 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6946 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6947 once the request has started to present itself.
6948
6949 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6950 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6951 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6952 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6953 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6954
6955 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6956 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6957 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6958 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6959
6960 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6961 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6962 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6963 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6964 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006965 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006966
6967 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6968 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6969 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6970 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6971
6972 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6973
6974
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006975timeout http-request <timeout>
6976 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006978 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006979 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006980 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006981 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6982 as explained at the top of this document.
6983
6984 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6985 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6986 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6987 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6988 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6989 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6990 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6991 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6992
6993 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6994 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006995 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6996 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006997
6998 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6999 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7000 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7001 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7002 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7003
7004 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007005 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7006 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7007 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007008
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007009 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007010
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007011
7012timeout queue <timeout>
7013 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7015 yes | no | yes | yes
7016 Arguments :
7017 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7018 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7019 as explained at the top of this document.
7020
7021 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7022 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7023 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7024 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7025 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7026
7027 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7028 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7029 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7030 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7031
7032 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7033
7034
7035timeout server <timeout>
7036timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7037 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7039 yes | no | yes | yes
7040 Arguments :
7041 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7042 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7043 as explained at the top of this document.
7044
7045 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7046 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7047 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7048 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7049 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7050 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7051 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7052
7053 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7054 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7055 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7056 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7057 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007058 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007059 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007060 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7061 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7062 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7063 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007064
7065 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7066 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7067 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7068 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7069 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7070 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7071
7072 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7073 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7074 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7075
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007076 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007077
7078
7079timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007080 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7082 yes | yes | yes | yes
7083 Arguments :
7084 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7085 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7086 as explained at the top of this document.
7087
7088 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7089 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7090 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7091
7092 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7093 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7094 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7095 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007096 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007097
7098 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7099
7100
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007101timeout tunnel <timeout>
7102 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7104 yes | no | yes | yes
7105 Arguments :
7106 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7107 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7108 as explained at the top of this document.
7109
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007110 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007111 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7112 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7113 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7114 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7115 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7116 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7117 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7118 specified.
7119
7120 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7121 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7122 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7123 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7124 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7125
7126 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7127 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7128 forget about it.
7129
7130 Example :
7131 defaults http
7132 option http-server-close
7133 timeout connect 5s
7134 timeout client 30s
7135 timeout client 30s
7136 timeout server 30s
7137 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7138
7139 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
7140
7141
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007142transparent (deprecated)
7143 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007145 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007146 Arguments : none
7147
7148 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
7149 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7150 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7151 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7152 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7153 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7154 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7155 appropriate server.
7156
7157 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
7158
7159 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7160 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7161
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007162 See also: "option transparent"
7163
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007164unique-id-format <string>
7165 Generate a unique ID for each request.
7166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7167 yes | yes | yes | no
7168 Arguments :
7169 <string> is a log-format string.
7170
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007171 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
7172 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
7173 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
7174 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007175
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007176 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
7177 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
7178 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
7179 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
7180 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
7181 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
7182 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
7183 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007184
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007185 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
7186 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007187
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007188 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007189
7190 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7191
7192 will generate:
7193
7194 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7195
7196 See also: "unique-id-header"
7197
7198unique-id-header <name>
7199 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
7200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7201 yes | yes | yes | no
7202 Arguments :
7203 <name> is the name of the header.
7204
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007205 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
7206 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007207
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007208 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007209
7210 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7211 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
7212
7213 will generate:
7214
7215 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7216
7217 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007218
7219use_backend <backend> if <condition>
7220use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007221 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7223 no | yes | yes | no
7224 Arguments :
7225 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
7226
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007227 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007228
7229 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
7230 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
7231 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007232 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
7233 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
7234 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
7235 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007236
7237 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
7238 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
7239 assign the backend.
7240
7241 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
7242 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7243 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
7244 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
7245 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
7246 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
7247
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007248 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007249 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007250 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
7251 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
7252 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
7253
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007254 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007255
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007256
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007257use-server <server> if <condition>
7258use-server <server> unless <condition>
7259 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
7260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7261 no | no | yes | yes
7262 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007263 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007264
7265 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
7266
7267 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
7268 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
7269 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
7270
7271 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
7272 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
7273 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
7274 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
7275 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
7276 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
7277 matches will assign the server.
7278
7279 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
7280 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
7281 with the next rules until one matches.
7282
7283 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
7284 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7285 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
7286 according to other persistence mechanisms.
7287
7288 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
7289 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
7290 stripped.
7291
7292 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
7293 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
7294 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
7295 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
7296
7297 Example :
7298 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
7299 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
7300 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
7301 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
7302 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
7303 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
7304 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
7305 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
7306 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
7307
7308 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
7309
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007310
73115. Bind and Server options
7312--------------------------
7313
7314The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
7315depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
7316settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
7317written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
7318described in this section.
7319
7320
73215.1. Bind options
7322-----------------
7323
7324The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
7325as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
7326no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
7327parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
7328while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
7329provided immediately after the setting name.
7330
7331The currently supported settings are the following ones.
7332
7333accept-proxy
7334 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
7335 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
7336 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
7337 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
7338 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
7339 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
7340 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
7341 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
7342 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007343 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
7344 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007345
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007346alpn <protocols>
7347 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
7348 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
7349 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
7350 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
7351 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
7352 initial NPN extension.
7353
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007354backlog <backlog>
7355 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
7356 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
7357
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007358ecdhe <named curve>
7359 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01007360 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
7361 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007362
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007363ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007364 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7365 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7366 client's certificate.
7367
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007368ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
7369 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7370 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
7371 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
7372 error is ignored.
7373
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007374ciphers <ciphers>
7375 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7376 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
7377 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
7378 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
7379 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
7380
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007381crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007382 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7383 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7384 to verify client's certificate.
7385
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007386crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007387 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7388 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
7389 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
7390 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
7391 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
7392 file.
7393
7394 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
7395 are loaded.
7396
7397 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
7398 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
7399 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
7400 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
7401 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
7402 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
7403 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
7404 www.sub.example.org).
7405
7406 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
7407 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
7408 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
7409 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
7410 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
7411
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007412 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007413
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007414 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
7415 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
7416 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires a intermediate CA (for
7417 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
7418 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
7419 clients).
7420
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007421crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007422 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
7423 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
7424 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an error
7425 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007426
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007427crt-list <file>
7428 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007429 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
7430 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007431
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007432 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007433
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007434 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
7435 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
7436 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
7437 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
7438 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
7439 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
7440 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
7441 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007442
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007443defer-accept
7444 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7445 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
7446 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
7447 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
7448 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
7449 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
7450 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
7451 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
7452 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
7453 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
7454 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7455
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007456force-sslv3
7457 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7458 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
7459 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7460
7461force-tlsv10
7462 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7463 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7464
7465force-tlsv11
7466 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7467 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7468
7469force-tlsv12
7470 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7471 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7472
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007473gid <gid>
7474 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
7475 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7476 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
7477 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
7478 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7479
7480group <group>
7481 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
7482 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
7483 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
7484 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
7485 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7486
7487id <id>
7488 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
7489 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
7490 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
7491 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
7492
7493interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01007494 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
7495 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
7496 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
7497 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
7498 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
7499 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
7500 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007501
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02007502level <level>
7503 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
7504 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
7505 sockets. <level> can be one of :
7506 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
7507 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
7508 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
7509 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
7510 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
7511 counters).
7512 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
7513 all counters).
7514
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007515maxconn <maxconn>
7516 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
7517 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
7518 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
7519 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
7520 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
7521 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
7522 eat all memory.
7523
7524mode <mode>
7525 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
7526 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
7527 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
7528 UNIX sockets.
7529
7530mss <maxseg>
7531 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
7532 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
7533 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
7534 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
7535 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
7536 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
7537 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
7538 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
7539 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
7540 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
7541 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
7542
7543name <name>
7544 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
7545 page.
7546
7547nice <nice>
7548 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
7549 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
7550 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
7551 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
7552 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
7553 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
7554 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
7555 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
7556 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
7557 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
7558 one for an RDP socket.
7559
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007560no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007561 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7562 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
7563 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007564 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7565 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007566
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02007567no-tls-tickets
7568 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7569 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7570 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7571 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
7572
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007573no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007574 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007575 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7576 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7577 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7578 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007579
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007580no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007581 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007582 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7583 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7584 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7585 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007586
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007587no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007588 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007589 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7590 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7591 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7592 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007593
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007594npn <protocols>
7595 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7596 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7597 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
7598 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007599 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
7600 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007601
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007602ssl
7603 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7604 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
7605 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
7606 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
7607 to deciphered contents.
7608
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01007609strict-sni
7610 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
7611 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
7612 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
7613 See the "crt" option for more information.
7614
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007615tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01007616 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007617 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7618 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7619 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7620 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7621 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7622 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7623 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02007624 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
7625 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
7626 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007627
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007628transparent
7629 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7630 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7631 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7632 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7633 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7634 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7635 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7636 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7637 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7638 so check for support with your vendor.
7639
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007640v4v6
7641 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7642 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
7643 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
7644 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
7645 sockets, and is overriden by the "v6only" option.
7646
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007647v6only
7648 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7649 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
7650 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007651 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
7652 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007653
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007654uid <uid>
7655 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
7656 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7657 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
7658 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
7659 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7660
7661user <user>
7662 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7663 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7664 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7665 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7666 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7667
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007668verify [none|optional|required]
7669 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7670 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7671 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7672 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7673 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007674 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
7675 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7676 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
7677 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007678
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020076795.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007680------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007681
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007682The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
7683which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
7684arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
7685settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
7686after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
7687Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
7688address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007690 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007691 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007692
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007693The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007694
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007695addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007696 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
7697 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
7698 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
7699 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
7700 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007701
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007702 Supported in default-server: No
7703
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007704backup
7705 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
7706 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
7707 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
7708 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
7709 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
7710 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007711
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007712 Supported in default-server: No
7713
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007714ca-file <cafile>
7715 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7716 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7717 server's certificate.
7718
7719 Supported in default-server: No
7720
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007721check
7722 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01007723 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
7724 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
7725 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
7726 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
7727 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
7728 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
7729 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09007730 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the
7731 "httpchk", "lb-agent-chk", "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and
7732 "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please refer to those options and parameters for
7733 more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007734
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007735 Supported in default-server: No
7736
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007737check-send-proxy
7738 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
7739 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
7740 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
7741 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
7742 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
7743 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
7744 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
7745
7746 Supported in default-server: No
7747
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007748check-ssl
7749 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
7750 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
7751 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
7752 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
7753 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
7754 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
7755 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
7756 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
7757 See the "ssl" option for more information.
7758
7759 Supported in default-server: No
7760
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007761ciphers <ciphers>
7762 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
7763 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
7764 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
7765 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
7766 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
7767 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
7768 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
7769 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
7770
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007771 Supported in default-server: No
7772
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007773cookie <value>
7774 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
7775 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
7776 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
7777 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
7778 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
7779 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
7780 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
7781
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007782 Supported in default-server: No
7783
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007784crl-file <crlfile>
7785 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7786 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7787 to verify server's certificate.
7788
7789 Supported in default-server: No
7790
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02007791crt <cert>
7792 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7793 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
7794 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
7795 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
7796 certificate request.
7797
7798 Supported in default-server: No
7799
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02007800disabled
7801 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
7802 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
7803 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
7804 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
7805 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
7806
7807 Supported in default-server: No
7808
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007809error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007810 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
7811 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
7812 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007813
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007814 Supported in default-server: Yes
7815
7816 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007817
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007818fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007819 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
7820 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
7821 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
7822
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007823 Supported in default-server: Yes
7824
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007825force-sslv3
7826 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7827 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
7828 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7829
7830 Supported in default-server: No
7831
7832force-tlsv10
7833 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7834 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7835
7836 Supported in default-server: No
7837
7838force-tlsv11
7839 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7840 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7841
7842 Supported in default-server: No
7843
7844force-tlsv12
7845 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7846 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7847
7848 Supported in default-server: No
7849
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007850id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007851 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
7852 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
7853 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007854
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007855 Supported in default-server: No
7856
7857inter <delay>
7858fastinter <delay>
7859downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007860 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
7861 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
7862 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
7863 between checks depending on the server state :
7864
7865 Server state | Interval used
7866 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7867 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
7868 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7869 Transitionally UP (going down), |
7870 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7871 or yet unchecked. |
7872 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7873 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7874 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007875
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007876 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
7877 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
7878 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
7879 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
7880 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
7881 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
7882 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
7883 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
7884 servers.
7885
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007886 Supported in default-server: Yes
7887
7888maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007889 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
7890 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
7891 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
7892 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
7893 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
7894 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
7895 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
7896 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
7897
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007898 Supported in default-server: Yes
7899
7900maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007901 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
7902 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
7903 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
7904 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
7905 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
7906 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
7907 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
7908
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007909 Supported in default-server: Yes
7910
7911minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007912 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
7913 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
7914 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
7915 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
7916 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
7917 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007918 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007919 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007920
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007921 Supported in default-server: Yes
7922
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007923no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007924 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
7925 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007926 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007927
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007928 Supported in default-server: No
7929
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02007930no-tls-tickets
7931 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7932 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7933 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7934 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
7935
7936 Supported in default-server: No
7937
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007938no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007939 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007940 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7941 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007942 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7943 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007944
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007945 Supported in default-server: No
7946
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007947no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007948 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007949 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7950 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007951 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7952 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007953
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007954 Supported in default-server: No
7955
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007956no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007957 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007958 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7959 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007960 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7961 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007962
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007963 Supported in default-server: No
7964
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09007965non-stick
7966 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
7967 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
7968 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
7969
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007970 Supported in default-server: No
7971
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007972observe <mode>
7973 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
7974 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
7975 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
7976 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
7977 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
7978 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01007979 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007980
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007981 Supported in default-server: No
7982
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007983 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
7984
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007985on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007986 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
7987 Currently, four modes are available:
7988 - fastinter: force fastinter
7989 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
7990 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
7991 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
7992 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
7993
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007994 Supported in default-server: Yes
7995
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007996 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
7997
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007998on-marked-down <action>
7999 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
8000 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008001 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
8002 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
8003 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
8004 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
8005 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
8006 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
8007 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
8008 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008009
8010 Actions are disabled by default
8011
8012 Supported in default-server: Yes
8013
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008014on-marked-up <action>
8015 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
8016 Currently one action is available:
8017 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
8018 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
8019 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
8020 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
8021 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
8022 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
8023 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
8024 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
8025
8026 Actions are disabled by default
8027
8028 Supported in default-server: Yes
8029
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008030port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008031 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
8032 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
8033 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
8034 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
8035 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
8036 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
8037
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008038 Supported in default-server: Yes
8039
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008040redir <prefix>
8041 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
8042 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
8043 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
8044 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
8045 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
8046 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
8047 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
8048 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008049 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008050 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
8051 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
8052 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
8053 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
8054 loop between the client and HAProxy!
8055
8056 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
8057
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008058 Supported in default-server: No
8059
8060rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008061 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
8062 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
8063 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
8064
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008065 Supported in default-server: Yes
8066
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008067send-proxy
8068 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
8069 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
8070 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
8071 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
8072 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
8073 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
8074 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
8075 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
8076 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008077 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
8078 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
8079 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
8080 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
8081 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008082
8083 Supported in default-server: No
8084
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008085slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008086 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
8087 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
8088 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
8089 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
8090 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
8091 parameters :
8092
8093 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
8094 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
8095
8096 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
8097 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
8098 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
8099 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
8100
8101 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
8102 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
8103 seen as failed.
8104
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008105 Supported in default-server: Yes
8106
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008107source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008108source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008109source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008110 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
8111 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
8112 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
8113 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
8114
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008115 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
8116 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
8117 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
8118 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
8119 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
8120 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
8121 server.
8122
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008123 Supported in default-server: No
8124
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008125ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008126 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
8127 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
8128 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
8129 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
8130 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
8131 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
8132 See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008133
8134 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008135
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008136track [<proxy>/]<server>
8137 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
8138 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
8139 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
8140 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
8141 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
8142
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008143 Supported in default-server: No
8144
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008145verify [none|required]
8146 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8147 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. This is the default. In the
8148 other case, The certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from
8149 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008150 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
8151 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
8152 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008153
8154 Supported in default-server: No
8155
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07008156verifyhost <hostname>
8157 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
8158 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
8159 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
8160 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
8161 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
8162 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
8163
8164 Supported in default-server: No
8165
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008166weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008167 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
8168 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
8169 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02008170 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
8171 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
8172 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
8173 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
8174 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
8175 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008176
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008177 Supported in default-server: Yes
8178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008179
81806. HTTP header manipulation
8181---------------------------
8182
8183In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
8184response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
8185request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
8186which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
8187against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
8188to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
8189passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
8190headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
8191never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
8192
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008193There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
8194(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
8195rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
8196messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
8197in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008198happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008199add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
8200normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
8201
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008202This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
8203in section 4.2 :
8204
8205 - reqadd <string>
8206 - reqallow <search>
8207 - reqiallow <search>
8208 - reqdel <search>
8209 - reqidel <search>
8210 - reqdeny <search>
8211 - reqideny <search>
8212 - reqpass <search>
8213 - reqipass <search>
8214 - reqrep <search> <replace>
8215 - reqirep <search> <replace>
8216 - reqtarpit <search>
8217 - reqitarpit <search>
8218 - rspadd <string>
8219 - rspdel <search>
8220 - rspidel <search>
8221 - rspdeny <search>
8222 - rspideny <search>
8223 - rsprep <search> <replace>
8224 - rspirep <search> <replace>
8225
8226With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
8227is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
8228parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
8229prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
8230Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
8231
8232 \t for a tab
8233 \r for a carriage return (CR)
8234 \n for a new line (LF)
8235 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
8236 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
8237 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
8238 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
8239 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
8240
8241The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
8242portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
8243above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
8244regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
82459 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
8246is very common to users of the "sed" program.
8247
8248The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
8249after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
8250
8251Notes related to these keywords :
8252---------------------------------
8253 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
8254 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
8255 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
8256
8257 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
8258 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
8259 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
8260
8261 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
8262 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
8263 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
8264 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
8265 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
8266
8267 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
8268 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
8269 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
8270 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
8271 useless headers before adding new ones.
8272
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008273 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008274 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
8275
8276 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
8277 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
8278 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
8279
8280 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
8281 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008282 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008283
8284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020082857. Using ACLs and fetching samples
8286----------------------------------
8287
8288Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
8289client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
8290The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
8291these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
8292but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
8293data called patterns.
8294
8295
82967.1. ACL basics
8297---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008298
8299The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
8300content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
8301from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
8302simple :
8303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008304 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
8305 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
8306 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008308The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
8309adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008310
8311In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
8312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008313 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008314
8315This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
8316Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
8317and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
8318an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
8319of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
8320
8321ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
8322'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
8323which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
8324
8325There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
8326performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
8327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008328The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
8329specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
8330this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
8331methods of a same sample fetch method.
8332
8333Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
8334 - boolean
8335 - integer (signed or unsigned)
8336 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
8337 - string
8338 - data block
8339
8340The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
8341 - boolean
8342 - integer or integer range
8343 - IP address / network
8344 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
8345 - regular expression
8346 - hex block
8347
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008348The following ACL flags are currently supported :
8349
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008350 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
8351 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008352 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008353 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
8354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008355The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
8356read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
8357if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
8358lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
8359will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
8360beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
8361a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
8362lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
8363exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
8364
8365Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
8366loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
8367
8368 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
8369
8370In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
8371the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
8372case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
8373as well.
8374
8375The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
8376sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
8377do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
8378methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
8379is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
8380obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
8381followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
8382default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
8383that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
8384string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
8385
8386There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
8387sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
8388be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008389
8390 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
8391 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008392 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
8393 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
8394 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
8395 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008396
8397 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
8398 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008399 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008400
8401 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008402 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008403
8404 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008405 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008406
8407 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
8408 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
8409
8410 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
8411 binary or string samples.
8412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008413 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
8414 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008416 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
8417 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
8418 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008420 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
8421 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008423 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
8424 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008426 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
8427 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008429 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
8430 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008431 This may be used with binary or string samples.
8432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008433 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
8434 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
8435 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008436
8437For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
8438request, it is possible to do :
8439
8440 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
8441
8442In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
8443buffer, one would use the following acl :
8444
8445 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
8446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008447All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
8448criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
8449method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
8450to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
8451criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
8452the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008454If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
8455the mathing method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method. For
8456example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008458 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
8459 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
8460 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
8461 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008462
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008464The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample fetch types
8465and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
8466combination the name of the matching method to be used, prefixed with "*" when
8467the method is implicit and will work by default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008469 +-------------------------------------------------+
8470 | Input sample type |
8471 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8472 | pattern type | boolean | integer | IP | string | binary |
8473 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8474 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
8475 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8476 | none (boolean value) | *bool | bool | | | |
8477 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8478 | integer (value) | int | *int | | | |
8479 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8480 | integer (length) | | | | len | len |
8481 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8482 | IP address | | | *ip | | |
8483 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8484 | exact string | | | | str | str |
8485 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8486 | prefix | | | | beg | beg |
8487 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8488 | suffix | | | | end | end |
8489 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8490 | substring | | | | sub | sub |
8491 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8492 | subdir | | | | dir | dir |
8493 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8494 | domain | | | | dom | dom |
8495 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8496 | regex | | | | reg | reg |
8497 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8498 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
8499 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008500
8501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020085027.1.1. Matching booleans
8503------------------------
8504
8505In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
8506Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
8507When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
8508that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
8509
8510Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
8511return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
8512"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
8513
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020085157.1.2. Matching integers
8516------------------------
8517
8518Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
8519enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
8520to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
8521
8522Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
8523matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
8524lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008525
8526For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
8527unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
8528representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
8529
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008530As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
8531two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
8532instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
8533ranges and operators.
8534
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008535For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008536operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
8537Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
8538of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008539
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008540Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008541
8542 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
8543 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
8544 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
8545 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
8546 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
8547
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008548For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008549
8550 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
8551
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008552This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
8553
8554 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
8555
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020085577.1.3. Matching strings
8558-----------------------
8559
8560String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
8561different forms :
8562
8563 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
8564 patterns ;
8565
8566 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
8567 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
8568
8569 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
8570 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
8571
8572 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
8573 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
8574
8575 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
8576 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
8577 matches.
8578
8579 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
8580 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
8581 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008582
8583String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
8584exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
8585characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
8586string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
8587to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008588before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008589
8590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020085917.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
8592---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008593
8594Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
8595they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
8596possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
8597passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
8598the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008599the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
8600match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008601
8602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020086037.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
8604-------------------------------------
8605
8606It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
8607not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
8608a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
8609to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
8610digits may be used upper or lower case.
8611
8612Example :
8613 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
8614 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
8615
8616
86177.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
8618---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008619
8620IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
8621netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
8622within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008623host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008624difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
8625at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
8626does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
8627parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008628
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008629IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
8630Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
8631trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
8632IPv6 patterns.
8633
8634HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
8635following situations :
8636 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
8637 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
8638 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
8639 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
8640 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
8641 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
8642 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
8643 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
8644 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
8645 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
8646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008647
86487.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
8649----------------------------------
8650
8651Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
8652combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
8653
8654 - AND (implicit)
8655 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
8656 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008658A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008660 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02008661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008662Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
8663indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02008664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008665For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
8666"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
8667requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
8668is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
8669
8670 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8671 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
8672 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
8673 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
8674
8675To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
8676and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
8677
8678 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8679 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8680 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
8681 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
8682
8683 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
8684 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
8685 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
8686 use_backend www if host_www
8687
8688It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
8689expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
8690be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
8691the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
8692
8693 The following rule :
8694
8695 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8696 block if METH_POST missing_cl
8697
8698 Can also be written that way :
8699
8700 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
8701
8702It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
8703to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
8704simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
8705sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
8706good use is the following :
8707
8708 With named ACLs :
8709
8710 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8711 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8712 monitor fail if site_dead
8713
8714 With anonymous ACLs :
8715
8716 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
8717
8718See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
8719
8720
87217.3. Fetching samples
8722---------------------
8723
8724Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
8725against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
8726sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
8727ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
8728of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
8729available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
8730
8731This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
8732Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
8733compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
8734deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
8735
8736The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
8737matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
8738method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
8739indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
8740
8741As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
8742when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
8743mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
8744the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
8745ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
8746
8747Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
8748multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
8749when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
8750incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
8751are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
8752is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
8753all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
8754
8755Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
8756 - name
8757 - name(arg1)
8758 - name(arg1,arg2)
8759
8760At the moment, the stickiness features are the most advanced users of the
8761sample fetch system. The "stick on", and "stick store-request" directives
8762support sample fetch rules which allow a list of transformations to be applied
8763on top of the fetched sample, and the finaly result is automatically converted
8764to the type of the table. These transformations are enumerated as a series
Willy Tarreau833cc792013-07-24 15:34:19 +02008765of specific keywords after the sample fetch method. These keywords may equally
8766be appended immediately after the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a
8767comma. These keywords can also support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which
8768must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008770The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008772 lower Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed
8773 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
8774 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008776 upper Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed
8777 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
8778 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008780 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for
8781 lookups and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within
8782 a certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
8783 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
8784 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
8785
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02008786 http_date([<offset>])
8787 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to
8788 a string representing this date in a format suitable for use
8789 in HTTP header fields. If an offset value is specified, then
8790 it is a number of seconds that is added to the date before the
8791 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit
8792 Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined
8793 with a positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the
8794 offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008795
87967.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
8797--------------------------------------------
8798
8799A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
8800not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
8801"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
8802The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
8803
8804always_false : boolean
8805 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
8806 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
8807
8808always_true : boolean
8809 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
8810 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
8811
8812avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008813 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008814 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
8815 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
8816 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
8817 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
8818 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
8819 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
8820 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
8821 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
8822 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
8823 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
8824 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
8825 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
8826 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01008827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008828be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008829 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
8830 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
8831 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
8832 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
8833 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008835be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
8836 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
8837 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
8838 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
8839 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
8840 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
8841 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008842
8843 Example :
8844 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
8845 backend dynamic
8846 mode http
8847 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
8848 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008850connslots([<backend>]) : integer
8851 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
8852 still available in the backend, by totalizing the maximum amount of
8853 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
8854 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05008855
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008856 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008857 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008858 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
8859
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008860 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
8861 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008862
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008863 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008864 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008865 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008866 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
8867 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008868 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008869 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008870
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008871 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
8872 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008873 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008874 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008875
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02008876date([<offset>]) : integer
8877 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
8878 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
8879 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
8880 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02008881 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
8882
8883 Example :
8884
8885 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
8886 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02008887
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +02008888env(<name>) : string
8889 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
8890 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
8891 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
8892 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
8893 certain way.
8894
8895 Examples :
8896 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
8897 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
8898
8899 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
8900 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
8901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008902fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
8903 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008904 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
8905 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008906 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
8907 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
8908 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
8909 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
8910 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008912fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
8913 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
8914 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
8915 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
8916 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
8917 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
8918 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
8919 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
8920 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008921
8922 Example :
8923 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
8924 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
8925 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
8926 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
8927 frontend mail
8928 bind :25
8929 mode tcp
8930 maxconn 100
8931 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
8932 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
8933 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
8934 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008936nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
8937 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
8938 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
8939 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008940 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
8941 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
8942 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008944queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008945 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
8946 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
8947 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008948 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
8949 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
8950 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
8951 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
8952 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
8953
8954srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
8955 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
8956 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
8957 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
8958 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
8959 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
8960 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
8961 methods.
8962
8963srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
8964 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
8965 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
8966 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
8967 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
8968 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
8969 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
8970 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
8971
8972srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
8973 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
8974 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
8975 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mosly
8976 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
8977 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
8978 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
8979 overloading servers).
8980
8981 Example :
8982 # Redirect to a separate back
8983 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
8984 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
8985 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
8986
8987table_avl([<table>]) : integer
8988 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
8989 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
8990
8991table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
8992 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
8993 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
8994 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
8995
8996
89977.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
8998----------------------------------
8999
9000The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
9001closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
9002methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
9003sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
9004TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009005the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
9006counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
9007"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009008argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
9009the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
9010this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009011
9012be_id : integer
9013 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
9014 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
9015
9016dst : ip
9017 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
9018 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
9019 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9020 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
9021 RFC 4291.
9022
9023dst_conn : integer
9024 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9025 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
9026 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
9027 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
9028 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
9029 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
9030 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
9031 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009033dst_port : integer
9034 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
9035 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
9036 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
9037 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
9038 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
9039 an HTTP header.
9040
9041fe_id : integer
9042 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
9043 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
9044 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
9045
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009046sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9047sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9048sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9049sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009050 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
9051 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9052 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
9053
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009054sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9055sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9056sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9057sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009058 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
9059 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9060 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
9061
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009062sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9063sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9064sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9065sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009066 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
9067 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009068 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
9069 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
9070 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009071
9072 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9073 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009074 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9075 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
9076 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009077 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9078 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9079
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009080sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9081sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9082sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9083sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009084 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
9085 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
9086
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009087sc_conn_cur(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9088sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9089sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9090sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009091 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9092 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
9093 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
9094
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009095sc_conn_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9096sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9097sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9098sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009099 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
9100 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
9101 See also src_conn_rate.
9102
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009103sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9104sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9105sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9106sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009107 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009108 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009109
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009110sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9111sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9112sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9113sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009114 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9115 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
9116 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009117 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9118 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9119 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009120
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009121sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9122sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9123sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9124sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009125 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
9126 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
9127 See also src_http_err_cnt.
9128
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009129sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9130sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9131sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9132sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009133 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
9134 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9135 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
9136 src_http_err_rate.
9137
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009138sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9139sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9140sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9141sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009142 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9143 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9144 src_http_req_cnt.
9145
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009146sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9147sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9148sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9149sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009150 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9151 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
9152 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9153 src_http_req_rate.
9154
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009155sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9156sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9157sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9158sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009159 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009160 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
9161 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
9162 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
9163 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009164
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009165 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9166 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009167 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9168
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009169sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9170sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9171sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9172sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009173 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
9174 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9175 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9176 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
9177
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009178sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9179sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9180sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9181sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009182 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
9183 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9184 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9185 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
9186
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009187sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9188sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9189sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9190sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009191 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
9192 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
9193 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
9194 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009195 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009196 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
9197
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009198sc_sess_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9199sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9200sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9201sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009202 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
9203 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9204 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
9205 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
9206 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009207 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009208
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009209sc_tracked(<ctr>,[<table>]) : boolean
9210sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9211sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9212sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +02009213 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
9214 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
9215 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
9216
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009217sc_trackers(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9218sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9219sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9220sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009221 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9222 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009223 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009224 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
9225 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009226 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
9227 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
9228 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009230so_id : integer
9231 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
9232 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
9233 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009235src : ip
9236 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
9237 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
9238 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
9239 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
9240 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
9241 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
9242 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009244src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9245 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
9246 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
9247 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009248 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009250src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9251 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
9252 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009253 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009254 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009256src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9257 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9258 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9259 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
9260 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
9261 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
9262 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009263
9264 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9265 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
9266 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
9267 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009268 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009269 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9270 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009272src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009273 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009274 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009275 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009276 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009278src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009279 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009280 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
9281 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009282 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009284src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9285 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
9286 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9287 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009288 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009290src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009291 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009292 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009293 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009294 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009296src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009297 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009298 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009299 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
9300 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009301 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9302 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9303 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009305src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9306 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
9307 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009308 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009309 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009310 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009312src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9313 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
9314 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9315 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9316 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009317 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009319src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9320 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9321 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9322 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009323 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009325src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9326 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9327 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9328 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009329 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009330 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009332src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9333 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9334 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9335 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009336 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009337 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
9338 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009339
9340 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009341 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009342 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009344src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9345 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
9346 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9347 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
9348 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009349 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
9350 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009352src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9353 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
9354 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009355 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
9356 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009357 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009359src_port : integer
9360 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
9361 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
9362 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
9363 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009365src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9366 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009367 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9368 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
9369 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009370 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009372src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9373 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
9374 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9375 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9376 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009377 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009379src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9380 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
9381 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
9382 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
9383 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
9384 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
9385 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
9386 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
9387 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009388
9389 Example :
9390 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
9391 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
9392 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
9393 listen ssh
9394 bind :22
9395 mode tcp
9396 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009397 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009398 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009399 server local 127.0.0.1:22
9400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009401srv_id : integer
9402 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
9403 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
9404 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02009405
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01009406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094077.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
9408----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02009409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009410The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
9411closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
9412when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
9413usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
9414future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negociations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02009415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009416ssl_c_ca_err : integer
9417 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9418 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
9419 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
9420 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
9421 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02009422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009423ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
9424 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9425 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
9426 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
9427 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009429ssl_c_err : integer
9430 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9431 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
9432 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
9433 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
9434 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009436ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9437 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9438 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
9439 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9440 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9441 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9442 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9443 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9444 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009446 ACL derivatives :
9447 ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009449ssl_c_key_alg : string
9450 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
9451 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9452 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009454 ACL derivatives :
9455 ssl_c_key_alg : exact string match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009457ssl_c_notafter : string
9458 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
9459 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9460 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009462 ACL derivatives :
9463 ssl_c_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009465ssl_c_notbefore : string
9466 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
9467 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9468 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009470 ACL derivatives :
9471 ssl_c_notbefore : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009473ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9474 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9475 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
9476 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9477 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9478 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9479 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9480 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9481 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009483 ACL derivatives :
9484 ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009486ssl_c_serial : binary
9487 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
9488 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
9489 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009491 ACL derivatives :
9492 ssl_c_serial : hex block match
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009494ssl_c_sha1 : binary
9495 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
9496 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
9497 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009499ssl_c_sig_alg : string
9500 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
9501 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9502 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009504 ACL derivatives :
9505 ssl_c_sig_alg : exact string match
9506
9507ssl_c_used : boolean
9508 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
9509 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009511ssl_c_verify : integer
9512 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
9513 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
9514 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
9515 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009517ssl_c_version : integer
9518 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
9519 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009521ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9522 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9523 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
9524 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9525 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009526 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009527 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9528 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9529 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009531 ACL derivatives :
9532 ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009534ssl_f_key_alg : string
9535 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
9536 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
9537 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009539 ACL derivatives :
9540 ssl_f_key_alg : exact string match
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009542ssl_f_notafter : string
9543 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
9544 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9545 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009547 ACL derivatives :
9548 ssl_f_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009550ssl_f_notbefore : string
9551 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
9552 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9553 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009555 ACL derivatives :
9556 ssl_f_notbefore : exact string match
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009558ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9559 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9560 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
9561 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9562 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9563 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9564 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9565 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9566 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009568 ACL derivatives :
9569 ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009571ssl_f_serial : binary
9572 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
9573 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
9574 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009576 ACL derivatives :
9577 ssl_f_serial : hex block match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009579ssl_f_sig_alg : string
9580 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
9581 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9582 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009584 ACL derivatives :
9585 ssl_f_sig_alg : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009587ssl_f_version : integer
9588 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
9589 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9590
9591ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009592 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
9593 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
9594 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
9595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009596 Example :
9597 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
9598 listen http-https
9599 bind :80
9600 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
9601 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
9602
9603ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
9604 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
9605 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9606
9607ssl_fc_alpn : string
9608 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negociation field from an
9609 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
9610 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
9611 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
9612 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
9613 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
9614 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
9615 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
9616 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
9617
9618 ACL derivatives :
9619 ssl_fc_alpn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009621ssl_fc_cipher : string
9622 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
9623 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009625 ACL derivatives :
9626 ssl_fc_cipher : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009628ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009629 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
9630 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009631 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
9632 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
9633 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
9634 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009636ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
9637 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009638 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
9639 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
9640 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9641 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009643ssl_fc_npn : string
9644 This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an incoming connection
9645 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
9646 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
9647 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9648 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
9649 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
9650 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
9651 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009653 ACL derivatives :
9654 ssl_fc_npn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009656ssl_fc_protocol : string
9657 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
9658 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009660 ACL derivatives :
9661 ssl_fc_protocol : exact string match
9662
9663ssl_fc_session_id : binary
9664 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
9665 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
9666 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
9667 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009669ssl_fc_sni : string
9670 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
9671 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
9672 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
9673 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
9674 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
9675
9676 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
9677 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
9678 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02009679 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
9680 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009682 ACL derivatives :
9683 ssl_fc_sni : exact string match
9684 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
9685 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009687ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
9688 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
9689 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02009690
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02009691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096927.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
9693------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02009694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009695Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
9696sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
9697only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
9698For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
9699be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
9700can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
9701sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
9702for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
9703content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009705payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
9706 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
9707 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
9708 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009710payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
9711 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
9712 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
9713 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009715req.len : integer
9716req_len : integer (deprecated)
9717 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
9718 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
9719 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
9720 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
9721 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
9722 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
9723 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
9724 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009726req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
9727 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +02009728 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
9729 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
9730 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
9731 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009733 ACL alternatives :
9734 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009736req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
9737 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
9738 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
9739 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
9740 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009742 ACL alternatives :
9743 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009745 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009747req.proto_http : boolean
9748req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
9749 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
9750 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
9751 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
9752 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
9753 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
9754 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
9755 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009757 Example:
9758 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9759 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
9760 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009761 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009763req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
9764rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
9765 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
9766 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
9767 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
9768 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
9769 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
9770 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
9771 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009773 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
9774 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
9775 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
9776 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
9777 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
9778 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009780 ACL derivatives :
9781 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009783 Example :
9784 listen tse-farm
9785 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
9786 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9787 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9788 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9789 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9790 persist rdp-cookie
9791 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
9792 # This is only useful makes sense if
9793 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
9794 stick-table type string size 204800
9795 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
9796 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9797 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009799 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
9800 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009802req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
9803rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
9804 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
9805 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
9806 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
9807 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009809 ACL derivatives :
9810 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009812req.ssl_hello_type : integer
9813req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
9814 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
9815 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
9816 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
9817 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
9818 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
9819 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
9820 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009822req.ssl_sni : string
9823req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
9824 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
9825 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
9826 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
9827 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
9828 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
9829 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
9830 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
9831 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
9832 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
9833 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
9834 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
9835 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009837 ACL derivatives :
9838 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009840 Examples :
9841 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
9842 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9843 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
9844 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
9845 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009847res.ssl_hello_type : integer
9848rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
9849 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
9850 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
9851 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
9852 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
9853 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
9854 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
9855 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02009856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009857req.ssl_ver : integer
9858req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
9859 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
9860 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
9861 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
9862 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
9863 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
9864 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
9865 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
9866 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
9867 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009869 ACL derivatives :
9870 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009871
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +02009872res.len : integer
9873 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
9874 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
9875 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
9876 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
9877 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
9878 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
9879 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
9880 content inspection.
9881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009882res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
9883 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +02009884 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
9885 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
9886 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
9887 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009889res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
9890 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
9891 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
9892 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
9893 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009895 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009897wait_end : boolean
9898 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
9899 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
9900 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
9901 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
9902 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
9903 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
9904 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
9905 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009907 Examples :
9908 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
9909 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
9910 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009912 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
9913 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
9914 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
9915 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
9916 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
9917 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
9918 tcp-request content reject
9919
9920
99217.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
9922--------------------------------------
9923
9924It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
9925This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
9926data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
9927its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
9928HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
9929content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
9930to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
9931more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
9932response are indexed.
9933
9934base : string
9935 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
9936 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
9937 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
9938 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
9939 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
9940 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
9941 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
9942 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
9943
9944 ACL derivatives :
9945 base : exact string match
9946 base_beg : prefix match
9947 base_dir : subdir match
9948 base_dom : domain match
9949 base_end : suffix match
9950 base_len : length match
9951 base_reg : regex match
9952 base_sub : substring match
9953
9954base32 : integer
9955 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
9956 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
9957 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
9958 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
9959
9960base32+src : binary
9961 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
9962 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
9963 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
9964 per-URL counters.
9965
9966req.cook([<name>]) : string
9967cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
9968 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
9969 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
9970 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
9971 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
9972 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
9973 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
9974 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
9975 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
9976
9977 ACL derivatives :
9978 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
9979 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
9980 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
9981 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
9982 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
9983 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
9984 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
9985 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009987req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
9988cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
9989 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
9990 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009992req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
9993cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
9994 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
9995 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
9996 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
9997 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009999cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10000 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10001 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
10002 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
10003 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
10004 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
10005 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
10006 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
10007 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
10008 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
10009 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010011hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10012 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
10013 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
10014 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
10015 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
10016 unambiguouslly apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010018req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
10019 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10020 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10021 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10022 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10023 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10024 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
10025 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
10026 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010028req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10029 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10030 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10031 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10032 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010034req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10035 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10036 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10037 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10038 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10039 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10040 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
10041 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
10042 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
10043 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
10044 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
10045 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010047 ACL derivatives :
10048 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10049 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10050 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10051 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10052 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10053 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10054 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10055 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10056
10057req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10058hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
10059 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10060 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
10061 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
10062 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
10063 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
10064 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
10065 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
10066 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
10067 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
10068
10069req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10070hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10071 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
10072 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
10073 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
10074 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10075 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10076 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10077 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
10078 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
10079
10080req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10081hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10082 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
10083 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
10084 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
10085 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10086 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10087 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10088 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
10089
10090http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
10091 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10092 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
10093 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10094 basic auth is supported.
10095
10096http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group
10097 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10098 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist, and
10099 whether that username belongs to one of the groups supplied in ACL patterns.
10100 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10101 basic auth is supported.
10102
10103 ACL derivatives :
10104 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : user group match
10105
10106http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010107 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
10108 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010109 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
10110 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010112method : integer + string
10113 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
10114 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
10115 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
10116 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
10117 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
10118 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
10119 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010121 ACL derivatives :
10122 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010124 Example :
10125 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
10126 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
10127 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010129path : string
10130 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
10131 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
10132 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
10133 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
10134 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
10135 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
10136 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010138 ACL derivatives :
10139 path : exact string match
10140 path_beg : prefix match
10141 path_dir : subdir match
10142 path_dom : domain match
10143 path_end : suffix match
10144 path_len : length match
10145 path_reg : regex match
10146 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010148req.ver : string
10149req_ver : string (deprecated)
10150 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
10151 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
10152 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010154 ACL derivatives :
10155 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010157res.comp : boolean
10158 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
10159 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
10160 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010162res.comp_algo : string
10163 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
10164 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
10165 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010167res.cook([<name>]) : string
10168scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10169 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10170 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10171 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010173 ACL derivatives :
10174 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010176res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10177scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10178 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10179 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
10180 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010182res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10183scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10184 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10185 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
10186 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010188res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10189 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10190 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10191 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10192 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10193 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
10194 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
10195 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
10196 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
10197 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010199res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10200 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10201 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10202 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10203 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
10204 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010206res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10207shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
10208 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10209 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10210 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10211 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10212 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
10213 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
10214 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
10215 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010217 ACL derivatives :
10218 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10219 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10220 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10221 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10222 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10223 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10224 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10225 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10226
10227res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10228shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10229 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10230 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10231 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
10232 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
10233 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010235res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10236shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10237 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
10238 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
10239 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
10240 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
10241 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
10242 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010244res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10245shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10246 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
10247 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10248 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10249 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10250 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
10251 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010253res.ver : string
10254resp_ver : string (deprecated)
10255 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
10256 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010258 ACL derivatives :
10259 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010261set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10262 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10263 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
10264 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
10265 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010267 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
10268 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010270 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010272status : integer
10273 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
10274 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
10275 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010277url : string
10278 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
10279 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
10280 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
10281 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
10282 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
10283 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
10284 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010286 ACL derivatives :
10287 url : exact string match
10288 url_beg : prefix match
10289 url_dir : subdir match
10290 url_dom : domain match
10291 url_end : suffix match
10292 url_len : length match
10293 url_reg : regex match
10294 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010296url_ip : ip
10297 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
10298 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
10299 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
10300 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
10301 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
10302 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10303 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010305url_port : integer
10306 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
10307 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
10308 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10309 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010311urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10312url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10313 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
10314 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
10315 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
10316 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
10317 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
10318 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
10319 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
10320 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
10321 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010323 ACL derivatives :
10324 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
10325 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
10326 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
10327 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
10328 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
10329 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
10330 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
10331 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010332
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010334 Example :
10335 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
10336 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
10337 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
10338 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010340urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
10341 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
10342 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
10343 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020010344
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010010345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200103467.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010347---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010348
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010349Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
10350every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010351order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010352
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010353ACL name Equivalent to Usage
10354---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010355FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020010356HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010357HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
10358HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010359HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
10360HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
10361HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
10362HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
10363LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010364METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
10365METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
10366METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
10367METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
10368METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
10369METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010370RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010371REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010372TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010373WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
10374---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010375
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103778. Logging
10378----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010379
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010380One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
10381provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
10382very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
10383provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
10384state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010385to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010386headers.
10387
10388In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
10389about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
10390send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
10391
10392 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
10393 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
10394 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
10395 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
10396 at the termination.
10397
10398The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
10399allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
10400as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
10401while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
10402real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
10403delay.
10404
10405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104068.1. Log levels
10407---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010408
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010409TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010410source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010411HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
10412in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
10413track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
10414syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
10415about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010416
10417
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104188.2. Log formats
10419----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010420
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010421HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010422and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
10423slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
10424options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010425
10426 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
10427 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
10428 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
10429 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
10430 extents.
10431
10432 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
10433 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
10434 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
10435 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
10436 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
10437
10438 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
10439 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
10440 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
10441 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
10442 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
10443
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010444 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
10445 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
10446 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
10447 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
10448
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010449 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
10450
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010451Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
10452specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
10453field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
10454servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
10455always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
10456identifier.
10457
10458Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
10459 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
10460 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
10461 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
10462 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
10463
10464
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104658.2.1. Default log format
10466-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010467
10468This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
10469as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
10470format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
10471
10472 Example :
10473 listen www
10474 mode http
10475 log global
10476 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10477
10478 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
10479 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
10480 (www/HTTP)
10481
10482 Field Format Extract from the example above
10483 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
10484 2 'Connect from' Connect from
10485 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
10486 4 'to' to
10487 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
10488 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
10489
10490Detailed fields description :
10491 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
10492 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
10493 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
10494 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
10495 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10496 and processed the connection.
10497 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
10498
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010499In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
10500"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
10501connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
10502
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010503It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
10504will eventually disappear.
10505
10506
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200105078.2.2. TCP log format
10508---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010509
10510The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
10511is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
10512information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
10513counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
10514emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
10515environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
10516the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
10517sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010518specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
10519not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
10520fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
10521marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010522
10523 Example :
10524 frontend fnt
10525 mode tcp
10526 option tcplog
10527 log global
10528 default_backend bck
10529
10530 backend bck
10531 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10532
10533 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
10534 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
10535 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
10536
10537 Field Format Extract from the example above
10538 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
10539 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
10540 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
10541 4 frontend_name fnt
10542 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
10543 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
10544 7 bytes_read* 212
10545 8 termination_state --
10546 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
10547 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
10548
10549Detailed fields description :
10550 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010551 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
10552 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
10553 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
10554 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
10555 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010556
10557 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010558 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
10559 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
10560 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010561
10562 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
10563 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
10564 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
10565 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
10566
10567 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10568 and processed the connection.
10569
10570 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
10571 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
10572 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
10573 applications.
10574
10575 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
10576 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
10577 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
10578 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
10579 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
10580
10581 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
10582 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
10583 See "Timers" below for more details.
10584
10585 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
10586 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
10587 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
10588 "Timers" below for more details.
10589
10590 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
10591 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
10592 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
10593 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
10594 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
10595 details.
10596
10597 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
10598 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
10599 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
10600 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
10601 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
10602
10603 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
10604 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
10605 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
10606 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
10607 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
10608 for more details.
10609
10610 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010611 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010612 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
10613 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
10614 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010615 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010616
10617 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
10618 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
10619 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
10620 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
10621 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
10622 caused by a denial of service attack.
10623
10624 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
10625 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
10626 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
10627 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
10628 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
10629 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
10630 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
10631 denial of service attack.
10632
10633 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
10634 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
10635 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
10636 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
10637 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
10638 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
10639 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
10640 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
10641 be processed than on other servers.
10642
10643 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
10644 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
10645 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
10646 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
10647 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
10648 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
10649 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
10650 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
10651 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
10652 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
10653 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
10654 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10655 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10656
10657 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10658 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10659 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10660 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10661 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10662 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10663 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10664 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10665
10666 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10667 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10668 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10669 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10670 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10671 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10672 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10673 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10674 occurs.
10675
10676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200106778.2.3. HTTP log format
10678----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010679
10680The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
10681is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
10682the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
10683are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
10684emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
10685generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
10686"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
10687which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010688frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
10689is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010690
10691Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
10692slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
10693with a star ('*') after the field name below.
10694
10695 Example :
10696 frontend http-in
10697 mode http
10698 option httplog
10699 log global
10700 default_backend bck
10701
10702 backend static
10703 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10704
10705 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
10706 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
10707 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010708 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010709
10710 Field Format Extract from the example above
10711 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
10712 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
10713 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
10714 4 frontend_name http-in
10715 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
10716 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
10717 7 status_code 200
10718 8 bytes_read* 2750
10719 9 captured_request_cookie -
10720 10 captured_response_cookie -
10721 11 termination_state ----
10722 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
10723 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
10724 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
10725 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
10726 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010727
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010728
10729Detailed fields description :
10730 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010731 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
10732 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
10733 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
10734 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
10735 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010736
10737 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010738 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
10739 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
10740 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010741
10742 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
10743 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
10744 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
10745 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
10746 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
10747
10748 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10749 and processed the connection.
10750
10751 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
10752 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
10753 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
10754
10755 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
10756 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
10757 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
10758 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
10759 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
10760 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
10761
10762 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
10763 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
10764 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
10765 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
10766 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
10767 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
10768
10769 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
10770 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
10771 See "Timers" below for more details.
10772
10773 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
10774 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
10775 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
10776 below for more details.
10777
10778 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
10779 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
10780 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
10781 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
10782 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
10783 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
10784 for more details.
10785
10786 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
10787 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
10788 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
10789 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
10790 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
10791 details.
10792
10793 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
10794 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
10795 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
10796
10797 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
10798 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
10799 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
10800 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
10801 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
10802 overflowing.
10803
10804 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
10805 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
10806 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
10807 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
10808 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
10809 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
10810 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
10811 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
10812
10813 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
10814 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
10815 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
10816 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
10817 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
10818 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
10819 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
10820 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
10821
10822 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
10823 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
10824 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
10825 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
10826 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
10827 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
10828 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
10829
10830 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010831 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010832 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
10833 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
10834 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010835 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010836 system.
10837
10838 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
10839 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
10840 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
10841 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
10842 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
10843 caused by a denial of service attack.
10844
10845 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
10846 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
10847 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
10848 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
10849 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
10850 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
10851 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
10852 denial of service attack.
10853
10854 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
10855 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
10856 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
10857 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
10858 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
10859 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
10860 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
10861 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
10862 processed than on other servers.
10863
10864 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
10865 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
10866 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
10867 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
10868 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
10869 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
10870 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
10871 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
10872 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
10873 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
10874 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
10875 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10876 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10877
10878 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10879 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10880 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10881 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10882 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10883 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10884 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10885 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10886
10887 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10888 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10889 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10890 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10891 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10892 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10893 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10894 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10895 occurs.
10896
10897 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
10898 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
10899 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
10900 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
10901 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
10902 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
10903 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
10904 cookies" below for more details.
10905
10906 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
10907 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
10908 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
10909 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
10910 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
10911 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
10912 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
10913 and cookies" below for more details.
10914
10915 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
10916 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
10917 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
10918 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
10919 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
10920 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
10921 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
10922 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
10923
10924
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200109258.2.4. Custom log format
10926------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010927
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010928The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010929mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010930
10931HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
10932Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
10933separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
10934prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
10935
10936Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
10937variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
10938string formats ("Q").
10939
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010010940If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010941as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010010942less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
10943the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
10944
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010945Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
10946HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
10947
10948Flags are :
10949 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010950 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010951
10952 Example:
10953
10954 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
10955 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
10956
10957At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
10958
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010959 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
10960 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010961
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010962the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010963
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010964 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010965 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010966 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010967
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010968and the default TCP format is defined this way :
10969
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010970 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010971 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
10972
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010973Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
10974
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010975 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010976 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010977 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10978 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
10979 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010980 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
10981 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
10982 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010983 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010984 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010985 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010986 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010987 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080010988 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010989 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
10990 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010991 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010992 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
10993 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010994 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010995 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
10996 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010997 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
10998 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
10999 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011000 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011001 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
11002 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011003 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011004 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11005 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
11006 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011007 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011008 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
11009 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
11010 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
11011 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011012 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011013 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011014 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011015 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011016 | H | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011017 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011018 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
11019 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
11020 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011021 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011022 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
11023 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011024 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011025 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011026 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011027 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011028
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011029 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011030
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010011031
110328.2.5. Error log format
11033-----------------------
11034
11035When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
11036protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
11037By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
11038"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
11039will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
11040logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
11041
11042The format looks like this :
11043
11044 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
11045 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
11046 Connection error during SSL handshake
11047
11048 Field Format Extract from the example above
11049 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
11050 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
11051 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
11052 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
11053 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
11054
11055These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
11056failures.
11057
11058
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110598.3. Advanced logging options
11060-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011061
11062Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
11063just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
11064options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
11065for more information about their usage.
11066
11067
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110688.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
11069------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011070
11071It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
11072haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
11073commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
11074monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
11075ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
11076
11077 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
11078 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
11079 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
11080 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
11081
11082 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
11083 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
11084 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
11085 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
11086 such as other load-balancers.
11087
11088 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
11089 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
11090 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
11091
11092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110938.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
11094----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011095
11096The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
11097what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
11098or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
11099"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
11100just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
11101log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
11102after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
11103is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
11104with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
11105with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
11106
11107
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111088.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
11109------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011110
11111Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
11112for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
11113"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
11114retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
11115raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
11116a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
11117file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
11118you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
11119"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
11120
11121
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111228.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
11123--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011124
11125Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
11126multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
11127them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
11128"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
11129logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
11130error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
11131and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
11132too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
11133useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
11134alternative.
11135
11136
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111378.4. Timing events
11138------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011139
11140Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
11141reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
11142the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
11143frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
11144mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
11145
11146 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
11147 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
11148 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
11149 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
11150 the client closes prematurely or times out.
11151
11152 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
11153 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
11154 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
11155 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
11156 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
11157
11158 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
11159 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
11160 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
11161 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
11162 connection never established.
11163
11164 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
11165 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
11166 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
11167 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
11168 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
11169 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
11170 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
11171 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
11172 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
11173 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
11174 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
11175
11176 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
11177 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
11178 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
11179 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
11180 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
11181
11182 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
11183
11184 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
11185 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
11186 negative.
11187
11188These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
11189protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
11190that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011191due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011192close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
11193session has been aborted on timeout.
11194
11195Most common cases :
11196
11197 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11198 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
11199 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
11200 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
11201 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
11202 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
11203 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
11204 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
11205 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020011206 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
11207 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
11208 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011209
11210 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11211 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
11212 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
11213 of ms on remote networks.
11214
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011215 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
11216 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
11217 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011218
11219 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
11220 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
11221 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
11222 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
11223 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
11224 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
11225 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
11226 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
11227 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
11228 to the server until another one is released.
11229
11230Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
11231
11232 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
11233 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
11234 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
11235
11236 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
11237 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
11238 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
11239
11240 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
11241 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
11242 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
11243 flags.
11244
11245 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
11246 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
11247 Check the session termination flags, then check the
11248 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
11249 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
11250 the client connection was maintained open.
11251
11252 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
11253 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
11254 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
11255 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
11256
11257
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112588.5. Session state at disconnection
11259-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011260
11261TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
11262"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
112632-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
11264each of which has a special meaning :
11265
11266 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
11267 session to terminate :
11268
11269 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
11270
11271 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
11272 server explicitly refused it.
11273
11274 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
11275 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
11276 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
11277 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020011278 (eg: cacheable cookie).
11279
11280 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
11281 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011282
11283 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
11284 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
11285 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
11286 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
11287 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
11288
11289 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
11290 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
11291 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
11292 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
11293 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
11294
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090011295 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
11296 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
11297
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011298 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
11299 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
11300 backup connections when going up.
11301
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020011302 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
11303
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011304 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
11305 send or receive data.
11306
11307 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
11308 send or receive data.
11309
11310 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
11311 with nothing left in the buffers.
11312
11313 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
11314
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010011315 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011316 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
11317
11318 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
11319 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
11320 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
11321 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
11322 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
11323
11324 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
11325 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
11326
11327 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
11328 server (HTTP only).
11329
11330 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
11331
11332 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
11333 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
11334 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
11335
11336 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
11337 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
11338 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
11339
11340 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
11341
11342 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
11343 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
11344
11345 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
11346 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
11347 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
11348
11349 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
11350 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020011351 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
11352 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011353
11354 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
11355 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
11356 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
11357 another server.
11358
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011359 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011360 server.
11361
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011362 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
11363 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
11364 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
11365 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
11366
11367 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
11368 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
11369 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
11370 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
11371
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020011372 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
11373 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
11374 "use-server" rule).
11375
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011376 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
11377
11378 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
11379 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
11380
11381 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
11382
11383 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
11384 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
11385 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
11386
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011387 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
11388 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
11389 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
11390 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
11391 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
11392
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011393 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
11394
11395 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
11396 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
11397
11398 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
11399
11400 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
11401
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011402The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
11403was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011404helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
11405starvation, attacks, etc...
11406
11407The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
11408alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
11409easier finding and understanding.
11410
11411 Flags Reason
11412
11413 -- Normal termination.
11414
11415 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
11416 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
11417 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
11418 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
11419
11420 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
11421 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
11422 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
11423 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
11424 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
11425 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011426
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011427 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
11428 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011429 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011430
11431 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
11432 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
11433 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
11434
11435 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
11436 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
11437 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
11438 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
11439 the server takes too long to respond.
11440
11441 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
11442 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
11443 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
11444 long a time to respond.
11445
11446 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
11447 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
11448 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
11449 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
11450 and the client.
11451
11452 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
11453 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
11454 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
11455 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
11456 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
11457 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
11458
11459 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
11460 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011461 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
11462 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
11463 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
11464 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011465
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020011466 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
11467 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
11468
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011469 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011470 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
11471 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
11472 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
11473 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
11474 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
11475
11476 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
11477 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
11478 503 or 504 here.
11479
11480 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
11481 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
11482 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
11483 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
11484 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
11485
11486 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
11487 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011488 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011489 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
11490 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
11491
11492 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
11493 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
11494 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
11495 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
11496 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
11497 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
11498 between haproxy and the server.
11499
11500 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
11501 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
11502 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
11503 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
11504 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
11505 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
11506 solution is to fix the application.
11507
11508 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
11509 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
11510 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
11511 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
11512 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
11513 external attacks.
11514
11515 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
11516 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011517 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011518 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
11519 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
11520
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011521 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
11522 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
11523 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020011524 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
11525 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011526
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011527 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
11528 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
11529 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
11530 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011531 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
11532 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
11533 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
11534 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
11535 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011536
11537 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
11538 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
11539 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
11540 returned an HTTP 403 error.
11541
11542 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
11543 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
11544 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
11545 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
11546
11547 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
11548 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
11549 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
11550 only be solved by proper system tuning.
11551
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011552The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
11553persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
11554important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
11555re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
11556
11557 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
11558
11559 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
11560 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
11561 set on a GET request.
11562
11563 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
11564 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011565 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011566 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
11567
11568 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
11569 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
11570 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
11571
11572 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
11573 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
11574 already got a cookie.
11575
11576 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
11577 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
11578 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
11579 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
11580 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
11581
11582 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
11583 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
11584 new cookie was inserted in the response.
11585
11586 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
11587 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
11588 new cookie was inserted in the response.
11589
11590 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
11591 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
11592
11593 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
11594 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
11595 then advertised in the response.
11596
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011597
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115988.6. Non-printable characters
11599-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011600
11601In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
11602consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
11603converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
11604prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
11605being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
11606escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
11607is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
11608'}' when logging headers.
11609
11610Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
11611issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
11612containing spaces is "User-Agent".
11613
11614Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
11615the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
11616performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
11617
11618
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116198.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
11620---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011621
11622Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
11623achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011624section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011625cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
11626the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
11627the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011628locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011629not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
11630user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
11631a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
11632wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
11633
11634 Examples :
11635 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
11636 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
11637
11638 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
11639 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
11640
11641
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116428.8. Capturing HTTP headers
11643---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011644
11645Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
11646proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
11647the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
11648server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
11649
11650Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
11651response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011652section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011653
11654It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011655time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
11656appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011657are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
11658and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
11659follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
11660request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
11661in the logs.
11662
11663 Example :
11664 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
11665 listen proxy-out
11666 mode http
11667 option httplog
11668 option logasap
11669 log global
11670 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
11671
11672 # log the name of the virtual server
11673 capture request header Host len 20
11674
11675 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
11676 capture request header Content-Length len 10
11677
11678 # log the beginning of the referrer
11679 capture request header Referer len 20
11680
11681 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
11682 capture response header Server len 20
11683
11684 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
11685 capture response header Content-Length len 10
11686
11687 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
11688 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
11689
11690 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
11691 capture response header Via len 20
11692
11693 # log the URL location during a redirection
11694 capture response header Location len 20
11695
11696 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
11697 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
11698 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11699 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
11700 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
11701
11702 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
11703 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
11704 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11705 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011706 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011707
11708 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
11709 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
11710 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11711 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
11712 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011713 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011714
11715
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117168.9. Examples of logs
11717---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011718
11719These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
11720them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
11721reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
11722
11723 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
11724 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
11725 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
11726
11727 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
11728 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
11729
11730 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
11731 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
11732 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
11733
11734 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
11735 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
11736
11737 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
11738 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
11739 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
11740
11741 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011742 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011743 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
11744 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
11745
11746 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
11747 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
11748 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
11749
11750 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
11751 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020011752 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011753 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
11754 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
11755 to return the 502 and not the server.
11756
11757 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011758 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011759
11760 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
11761 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
11762 Nothing was sent to any server.
11763
11764 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
11765 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
11766
11767 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
11768 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
11769 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
11770 send a 408 return code to the client.
11771
11772 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
11773 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
11774
11775 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
11776 5 seconds ("c----").
11777
11778 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
11779 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011780 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011781
11782 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011783 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011784 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
11785 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
11786 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
11787 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
11788 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011789
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011790
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117919. Statistics and monitoring
11792----------------------------
11793
11794It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
11795mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
11796CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
11797Unix socket.
11798
11799
118009.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011801---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011802
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010011803The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
11804page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
11805
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011806 0. pxname: proxy name
11807 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
11808 for server)
11809 2. qcur: current queued requests
11810 3. qmax: max queued requests
11811 4. scur: current sessions
11812 5. smax: max sessions
11813 6. slim: sessions limit
11814 7. stot: total sessions
11815 8. bin: bytes in
11816 9. bout: bytes out
11817 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011818 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011819 12. ereq: request errors
11820 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010011821 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011822 15. wretr: retries (warning)
11823 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010011824 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011825 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
11826 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
11827 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
11828 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
11829 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
11830 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
11831 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
11832 25. qlimit: queue limit
11833 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
11834 27. iid: unique proxy id
11835 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
11836 29. throttle: warm up status
11837 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
11838 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020011839 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020011840 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
11841 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
11842 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020011843 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011844 UNK -> unknown
11845 INI -> initializing
11846 SOCKERR -> socket error
11847 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
11848 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
11849 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
11850 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
11851 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
11852 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11853 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11854 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
11855 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
11856 disable-on-404
11857 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11858 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11859 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020011860 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
11861 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011862 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
11863 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
11864 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
11865 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
11866 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
11867 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011868 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
11869 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
11870 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
11871 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010011872 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
11873 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010011874 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
11875 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
11876 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010011877 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011878
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011879
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118809.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011881-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011882
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020011883The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
11884necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
11885A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
11886issuing commands by hand :
11887
11888 global
11889 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
11890 stats timeout 2m
11891
11892It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
11893the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
11894never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
11895situations :
11896
11897 global
11898 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
11899 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
11900 stats timeout 2m
11901
11902To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
11903swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
11904to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
11905syntaxes we'll use are the following :
11906
11907 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
11908 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
11909
11910The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
11911script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
11912for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
11913
11914The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
11915that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
11916editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
11917(eg: watch a counter).
11918
11919The socket supports two operation modes :
11920 - interactive
11921 - non-interactive
11922
11923The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
11924this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
11925sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
11926mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
11927commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
11928example :
11929
11930 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
11931
11932The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
11933entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
11934for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
11935sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
11936"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
11937after processing the last command of the same line.
11938
11939For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
11940"prompt" command :
11941
11942 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
11943 prompt
11944 > show info
11945 ...
11946 >
11947
11948Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
11949delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
11950that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
11951parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011952
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011953It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
11954on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
11955own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011956
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020011957The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
11958If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
11959all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
11960it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
11961
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011962clear counters
11963 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
11964 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
11965 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
11966 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
11967 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11968
11969clear counters all
11970 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
11971 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
11972 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
11973
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011974clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
11975 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
11976
11977 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
11978 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
11979 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
11980 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
11981 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
11982 later after the session ends is usual enough.
11983
11984 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
11985
11986 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
11987 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
11988 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
11989 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
11990 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
11991 the ACLs :
11992
11993 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11994 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11995 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11996 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11997 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11998 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11999
12000 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012001 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
12002 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012003
12004 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012005 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012006 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012007 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12008 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12009 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12010 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012011
12012 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12013
12014 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012015 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012016 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12017 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012018 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12019 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12020 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012021
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012022disable frontend <frontend>
12023 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
12024 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
12025 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
12026 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
12027 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
12028 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
12029 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
12030 on the stats page.
12031
12032 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12033 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12034
12035 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12036 level "admin".
12037
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012038disable server <backend>/<server>
12039 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
12040 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
12041 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
12042 during the maintenance.
12043
12044 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
12045 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
12046
12047 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012048 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012049
12050 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12051 level "admin".
12052
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012053enable frontend <frontend>
12054 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
12055 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
12056 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
12057 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
12058 which was disabled.
12059
12060 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12061 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12062
12063 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12064 level "admin".
12065
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012066enable server <backend>/<server>
12067 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
12068 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
12069
12070 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012071 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012072
12073 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12074 level "admin".
12075
12076get weight <backend>/<server>
12077 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
12078 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
12079 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
12080 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
12081 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012082 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012083
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012084help
12085 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
12086 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012087
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012088prompt
12089 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
12090 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
12091 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
12092 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
12093 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
12094 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
12095 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
12096 command.
12097
12098quit
12099 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012100
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012101set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020012102 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
12103 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
12104 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
12105 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
12106 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012107 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
12108 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12109
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020012110set maxconn global <maxconn>
12111 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
12112 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
12113 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
12114 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
12115 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
12116 setting.
12117
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020012118set rate-limit connections global <value>
12119 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
12120 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12121 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12122 is passed in number of connections per second.
12123
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012124set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
12125 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
12126 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010012127 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
12128 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012129
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012130set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012131 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
12132 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
12133 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
12134 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012135 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
12136 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012137
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012138set timeout cli <delay>
12139 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
12140 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
12141 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
12142
12143set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
12144 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
12145 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090012146 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
12147 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
12148 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
12149 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
12150 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
12151 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
12152 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
12153 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
12154 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
12155 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
12156 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
12157 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
12158 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012159
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012160show errors [<iid>]
12161 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
12162 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012163 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
12164 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
12165 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012166
12167 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
12168 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
12169 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
12170 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
12171 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
12172 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
12173 are reported too.
12174
12175 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
12176 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
12177 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
12178 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
12179 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
12180 code.
12181
12182 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
12183 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
12184 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
12185 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
12186 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
12187 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
12188 line.
12189
12190 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012191 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12192 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012193 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
12194 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
12195
12196 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
12197 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
12198 00038 Location: blah\r\n
12199 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
12200 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
12201 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
12202 00204+ minal\r\n
12203 00211 \r\n
12204
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012205 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012206 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
12207 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
12208 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
12209 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
12210 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
12211 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012212
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012213show info
12214 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
12215
12216show sess
12217 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012218 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
12219 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12220
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010012221show sess <id>
12222 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
12223 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12224 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
12225 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
12226 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010012227 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
12228 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
12229 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012230
12231show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
12232 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
12233 possible to dump only selected items :
12234 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
12235 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
12236 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
12237 for example:
12238 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
12239 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
12240 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
12241
12242 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012243 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
12244 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012245 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
12246 Release_date: 2009/09/23
12247 Nbproc: 1
12248 Process_num: 1
12249 (...)
12250
12251 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
12252 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
12253 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
12254 (...)
12255 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
12256
12257 $
12258
12259 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
12260 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
12261 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
12262 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012263 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012264
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012265show table
12266 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
12267 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
12268 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
12269 entries currently in use.
12270
12271 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012272 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012273 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
12274 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012275
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012276show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012277 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
12278 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
12279 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012280 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
12281
12282 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
12283 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
12284 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
12285 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
12286 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
12287
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012288 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12289 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12290 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12291 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12292 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12293 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12294
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012295
12296 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012297 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
12298 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012299
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012300 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012301 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012302 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012303 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12304 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12305 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12306 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012307
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012308 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012309 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012310 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12311 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012312
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012313 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
12314 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012315 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012316 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12317 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012318
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012319 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
12320 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012321 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012322 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12323 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
12324
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012325 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
12326 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
12327 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
12328 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
12329 time goes, the average event rate drops.
12330
12331 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
12332 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
12333 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012334 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
12335 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012336 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
12337 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020012338
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012339shutdown frontend <frontend>
12340 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
12341 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
12342 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
12343 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
12344 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
12345 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
12346 once it is terminated.
12347
12348 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12349 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12350
12351 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12352 level "admin".
12353
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020012354shutdown session <id>
12355 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
12356 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12357 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
12358 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
12359 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
12360 flag in the logs.
12361
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020012362shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
12363 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
12364 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
12365 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
12366 'K' flag in the logs.
12367
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012368/*
12369 * Local variables:
12370 * fill-column: 79
12371 * End:
12372 */